Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 19185:17d878a2ddaa v8.2.0151
patch 8.2.0151: detecting a script was already sourced is unreliable
Commit: https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/978d170bdce9c0a47e6683cd7c288bc2706f3fff
Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
Date: Sun Jan 26 17:38:12 2020 +0100
patch 8.2.0151: detecting a script was already sourced is unreliable
Problem: Detecting a script was already sourced is unreliable.
Solution: Do not use the inode number.
author | Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 26 Jan 2020 17:45:04 +0100 |
parents | 94eda51ba9ba |
children | 7be3663e2f2b |
rev | line source |
---|---|
19180 | 1 *options.txt* For Vim version 8.2. Last change: 2020 Jan 24 |
7 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
5 | |
6 | |
7 Options *options* | |
8 | |
9 1. Setting options |set-option| | |
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting| | |
11 3. Options summary |option-summary| | |
12 | |
10244
876fbdd84e52
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ec618c9feac4573b154510236ad8121c77d0eca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10218
diff
changeset
|
13 For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|. |
7 | 14 |
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to | |
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms: | |
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle* | |
18 number has a numeric value | |
19 string has a string value | |
20 | |
21 ============================================================================== | |
523 | 22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764* |
7 | 23 |
24 *:se* *:set* | |
19137
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
25 :se[t][!] Show all options that differ from their default value. |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
26 When [!] is present every option is on a separate |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
27 line. |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
28 |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
29 :se[t][!] all Show all but terminal options. |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
30 When [!] is present every option is on a separate |
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
31 line. |
7 | 32 |
33 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the | |
34 key codes are not shown, because they are generated | |
35 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal | |
36 codes in the GUI is not useful either... | |
37 | |
38 *E518* *E519* | |
39 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}. | |
40 | |
41 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on. | |
42 Number option: show value. | |
43 String option: show value. | |
44 | |
45 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off. | |
46 | |
2152 | 47 *:set-!* *:set-inv* |
7 | 48 :se[t] {option}! or |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
49 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. |
7 | 50 |
51 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim* | |
52 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
53 current value of 'compatible'. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
54 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
55 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. |
7 | 56 |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
57 :se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of |
7051
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
58 these options are not changed: |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
59 all terminal options, starting with t_ |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
60 'columns' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
61 'cryptmethod' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
62 'encoding' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
63 'key' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
64 'lines' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
65 'term' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
66 'ttymouse' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
67 'ttytype' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
68 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects. |
7 | 69 |
70 *:set-args* *E487* *E521* | |
71 :se[t] {option}={value} or | |
72 :se[t] {option}:{value} | |
73 Set string or number option to {value}. | |
74 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal, | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
75 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0'). |
7 | 76 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by |
77 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is | |
78 set). See |cmdline-completion|. | |
79 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and | |
80 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value} | |
81 is not allowed. | |
82 See |option-backslash| for using white space and | |
83 backslashes in {value}. | |
84 | |
85 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=* | |
86 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the | |
87 {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
88 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
89 value was empty. | |
90 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags | |
557 | 91 are removed. When adding a flag that was already |
92 present the option value doesn't change. | |
809 | 93 Also see |:set-args| above. |
7 | 94 |
95 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=* | |
96 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend | |
97 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
98 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
99 value was empty. | |
100 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
101 | |
102 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=* | |
103 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove | |
104 the {value} from a string option, if it is there. | |
105 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there | |
106 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma | |
107 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option | |
108 becomes empty. | |
109 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be | |
110 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags | |
111 one by one to avoid problems. | |
112 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
113 | |
114 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: > | |
115 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3 | |
116 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given | |
117 and the following arguments will be ignored. | |
118 | |
119 *:set-verbose* | |
120 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it | |
121 was last set. Example: > | |
122 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent? | |
14864 | 123 < shiftwidth=4 ~ |
124 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ | |
125 cindent ~ | |
126 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~ | |
1621 | 127 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose |
128 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument. | |
129 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. | |
7 | 130 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or |
131 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported. | |
132 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting | |
133 'compatible'. | |
1621 | 134 A few special texts: |
14864 | 135 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ |
1621 | 136 Option was set in a |modeline|. |
137 Last set from --cmd argument ~ | |
138 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +. | |
139 Last set from -c argument ~ | |
140 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or | |
141 |-q|. | |
142 Last set from environment variable ~ | |
143 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT, | |
144 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT. | |
145 Last set from error handler ~ | |
146 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error. | |
147 | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
148 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 149 |
150 *:set-termcap* *E522* | |
667 | 151 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will |
7 | 152 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If |
153 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: > | |
154 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot | |
155 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For | |
156 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: > | |
157 :set <M-b>=^[b | |
158 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it) | |
159 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations. | |
160 | |
2726 | 161 You can define any key codes, e.g.: > |
162 :set t_xy=^[foo; | |
163 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these | |
164 codes as you like: > | |
165 :map <t_xy> something | |
166 < *E846* | |
167 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its | |
168 value will result in an error: > | |
169 :set t_kb= | |
170 :set t_kb | |
171 E846: Key code not set: t_kb | |
172 | |
36 | 173 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
174 security reasons. | |
175 | |
7 | 176 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put |
10 | 177 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of |
7 | 178 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the |
179 |more-prompt|. | |
180 | |
181 *option-backslash* | |
182 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a | |
183 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this | |
184 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded | |
185 down). | |
186 A few examples: > | |
187 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags" | |
188 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file" | |
189 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file" | |
190 | |
10 | 191 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To |
192 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the | |
7 | 193 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": > |
194 :set titlestring=hi\|there | |
195 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": > | |
196 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there | |
197 | |
642 | 198 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in |
199 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring' | |
200 option to 'hi "there"': > | |
201 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\" | |
202 | |
18972 | 203 For Win32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More precise: For |
204 options that expect a file name (those where environment variables are | |
205 expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not removed. But | |
206 a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, etc.) is used | |
207 like explained above. | |
7 | 208 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": > |
209 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
210 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
211 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!) | |
212 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes | |
213 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be | |
10 | 214 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a |
7 | 215 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it. |
216 | |
217 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags* | |
218 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552* | |
219 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an | |
220 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: > | |
221 :set guioptions+=a | |
222 Remove a flag from an option like this: > | |
223 :set guioptions-=a | |
224 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'. | |
10 | 225 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has |
7 | 226 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba" |
227 doesn't appear. | |
228 | |
229 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var* | |
22 | 230 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the |
7 | 231 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable |
232 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name | |
233 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may | |
234 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is | |
235 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: > | |
236 :set term=$TERM.new | |
237 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,. | |
238 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set | |
239 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing. | |
240 | |
241 | |
242 Handling of local options *local-options* | |
243 | |
244 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
245 has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This |
7 | 246 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set |
247 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another. | |
248 | |
249 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific | |
250 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses | |
251 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user | |
252 expects is a bit complicated... | |
253 | |
254 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus | |
255 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same. | |
256 | |
257 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since | |
258 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer, | |
259 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a | |
260 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and | |
261 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed, | |
262 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer. | |
263 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
264 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
265 that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
266 window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
267 last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used. |
7 | 268 |
269 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer. | |
270 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep | |
271 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the | |
272 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window | |
273 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but | |
274 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: > | |
275 :e one | |
276 :set list | |
277 :e two | |
278 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list" | |
279 command you have also set the global value. > | |
280 :set nolist | |
281 :e one | |
282 :setlocal list | |
283 :e two | |
284 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global | |
285 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the | |
286 global value. Note that if you do this next: > | |
287 :e one | |
4358 | 288 You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one". |
289 The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also | |
290 happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is | |
291 wiped out |:bwipe|. | |
7 | 292 |
293 *:setl* *:setlocal* | |
19137
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
294 :setl[ocal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the |
7 | 295 current buffer or window. Not all options have a |
296 local value. If the option does not have a local | |
297 value the global value is set. | |
2413 | 298 With the "all" argument: display local values for all |
299 local options. | |
300 Without argument: Display local values for all local | |
301 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 302 When displaying a specific local option, show the |
1621 | 303 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when |
304 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed | |
305 before the option name. | |
306 For a global option the global value is | |
7 | 307 shown (but that might change in the future). |
308 | |
809 | 309 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by |
310 copying the value. | |
311 | |
3281 | 312 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of |
313 {option}, so that the global value will be used. | |
7 | 314 |
315 *:setg* *:setglobal* | |
19137
69f0e9b5c107
patch 8.2.0128: cannot list options one per line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19116
diff
changeset
|
316 :setg[lobal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local |
7 | 317 option without changing the local value. |
318 When displaying an option, the global value is shown. | |
2413 | 319 With the "all" argument: display global values for all |
320 local options. | |
321 Without argument: display global values for all local | |
322 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 323 |
324 For buffer-local and window-local options: | |
325 Command global value local value ~ | |
326 :set option=value set set | |
327 :setlocal option=value - set | |
328 :setglobal option=value set - | |
329 :set option? - display | |
330 :setlocal option? - display | |
331 :setglobal option? display - | |
332 | |
333 | |
334 Global options with a local value *global-local* | |
335 | |
40 | 336 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows. |
337 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value. | |
338 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then | |
339 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global | |
340 value. | |
7 | 341 |
342 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global | |
343 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: > | |
344 :set makeprg=gmake | |
345 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set | |
346 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too. | |
347 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use | |
1152 | 348 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source |
10 | 349 files. You use this command: > |
7 | 350 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake |
351 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: > | |
352 :setlocal makeprg= | |
15729 | 353 This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need |
354 to use the "<" flag, like this: > | |
7 | 355 :setlocal autoread< |
15729 | 356 Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global |
357 value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value | |
358 (that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: > | |
809 | 359 :set path< |
360 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is | |
361 used. Thus it does the same as: > | |
362 :setlocal path= | |
7 | 363 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using |
364 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then. | |
365 | |
366 | |
367 Setting the filetype | |
368 | |
11473 | 369 :setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype* |
7 | 370 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if |
371 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands. | |
372 This is short for: > | |
373 :if !did_filetype() | |
374 : setlocal filetype={filetype} | |
375 :endif | |
376 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid | |
377 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different | |
378 settings and syntax files to be loaded. | |
11473 | 379 |
380 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a | |
381 later :setfiletype command will override the | |
16023 | 382 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype |
383 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()| | |
384 will return false after this command. | |
11473 | 385 |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
386 *option-window* *optwin* |
7 | 387 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options* |
388 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options. | |
389 Options are grouped by function. | |
390 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the | |
391 short help to open a help window with more help for | |
392 the option. | |
393 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the | |
394 "set" line to set the new value. For window and | |
395 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is | |
396 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help | |
397 window, in which case the window below help window is | |
398 used (skipping the option-window). | |
13437 | 399 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
400 feature} | |
7 | 401 |
402 *$HOME* | |
403 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an | |
404 option and after a space or comma. | |
405 | |
406 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory | |
407 of user "user". Example: > | |
408 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,. | |
409 | |
410 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can | |
411 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the | |
412 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'. | |
413 | |
12254 | 414 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set" |
415 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let". | |
416 | |
417 *$HOME-windows* | |
3224 | 418 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then |
419 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH. | |
12499 | 420 If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used. |
421 | |
422 This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when | |
423 running an external command: > | |
424 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=') | |
425 and > | |
426 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")') | |
427 should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true. | |
428 When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the | |
429 subprocesses. | |
3224 | 430 |
7 | 431 |
432 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on | |
433 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. | |
434 | |
435 *:fix* *:fixdel* | |
436 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD': | |
437 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~ | |
438 CTRL-? CTRL-H | |
439 not CTRL-? CTRL-? | |
440 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
441 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) |
7 | 442 |
443 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the | |
444 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in | |
445 your .vimrc: > | |
446 :fixdel | |
447 < This works no matter what the actual code for | |
448 backspace is. | |
449 | |
450 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can | |
451 use this: > | |
452 :if &term == "termname" | |
453 : set t_kb=^V<BS> | |
454 : fixdel | |
455 :endif | |
456 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key | |
10 | 457 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname" |
7 | 458 with your terminal name. |
459 | |
460 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not | |
461 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: > | |
462 :if &term == "termname" | |
463 : set t_kD=^V<Delete> | |
464 :endif | |
465 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key | |
466 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname" | |
467 with your terminal name. | |
468 | |
469 *Linux-backspace* | |
470 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key | |
471 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by | |
472 putting this line in your rc.local: > | |
473 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys | |
474 < | |
475 *NetBSD-backspace* | |
476 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce | |
477 the right code, try this: > | |
478 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace" | |
479 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: > | |
480 keysym 22 = BackSpace | |
481 < You need to restart for this to take effect. | |
482 | |
483 ============================================================================== | |
484 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting* | |
485 | |
486 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives | |
487 to set options automatically for one or more files: | |
488 | |
489 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See | |
490 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions, | |
491 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started. | |
492 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and | |
493 |:mksession|. | |
494 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed. | |
495 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and | |
496 many other things. See |autocommand|. | |
497 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a | |
498 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for | |
499 modelines. This is explained here. | |
500 | |
501 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520* | |
502 There are two forms of modelines. The first form: | |
18831 | 503 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options} |
504 | |
505 [text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank | |
506 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at | |
507 least one blank character | |
5055 | 508 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:" |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
509 [white] optional white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
510 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
511 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
512 for a ":set" command (can be empty) |
7 | 513 |
5055 | 514 Examples: |
782 | 515 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~ |
5055 | 516 vim: tw=77 ~ |
7 | 517 |
518 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi): | |
519 | |
19163 | 520 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text] |
521 | |
522 [text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank | |
523 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at | |
524 least one blank character | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
525 {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:" |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
526 [white] optional white space |
5055 | 527 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When |
528 "Vim" is used it must be "set". | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
529 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
530 is the argument for a ":set" command |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
531 : a colon |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
532 [text] any text or empty |
7 | 533 |
5055 | 534 Examples: |
782 | 535 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
5055 | 536 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
7 | 537 |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
538 The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
539 chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
540 "vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
541 version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
542 could be short for "example:"). |
7 | 543 |
544 *modeline-local* | |
545 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the | |
11 | 546 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global |
547 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and | |
548 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result | |
549 depends on which one was opened last. | |
7 | 550 |
23 | 551 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options |
552 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local | |
553 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer | |
554 in another window. But window-local options will be set. | |
555 | |
7 | 556 *modeline-version* |
557 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
558 number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used: |
7 | 559 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later |
560 vim<{vers}: version before {vers} | |
561 vim={vers}: version {vers} | |
562 vim>{vers}: version after {vers} | |
6647 | 563 {vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor). |
564 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0: | |
565 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~ | |
566 To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2: | |
567 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~ | |
7 | 568 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":". |
569 | |
570 | |
571 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option. | |
572 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked. | |
573 | |
574 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line | |
782 | 575 like: |
576 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~ | |
577 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: | |
578 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~ | |
7 | 579 |
580 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped. | |
581 | |
582 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The | |
782 | 583 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: |
18928 | 584 /* vi:set fillchars=stl\:^,vert\:\|: */ ~ |
585 This sets the 'fillchars' option to "stl:^,vert:\|". Only a single backslash | |
586 before the ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:". | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
587 *E992* |
7 | 588 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody |
1111 | 589 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
590 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when the value is used |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
591 the |sandbox| is effective. Some options can only be set from the modeline |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
592 when 'modelineexpr' is set (the default is off). |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
593 |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
594 Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline causes trouble. E.g., |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
595 when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines are wrapped unexpectedly. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
596 So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. The mail ftplugin does |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
597 this, for example. |
7 | 598 |
599 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could | |
600 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For | |
601 example: > | |
602 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif | |
603 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing | |
604 "VAR". | |
605 | |
606 ============================================================================== | |
607 3. Options summary *option-summary* | |
608 | |
609 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with | |
610 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used. | |
611 | |
612 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option" | |
613 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used. | |
614 | |
615 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is | |
616 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when | |
617 'compatible' is set. | |
618 | |
619 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that | |
10 | 620 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a |
7 | 621 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in |
622 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view | |
623 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain | |
624 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example | |
625 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C | |
626 program. | |
627 | |
628 global one option for all buffers and windows | |
629 local to window each window has its own copy of this option | |
630 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option | |
631 | |
632 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window | |
633 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the | |
634 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the | |
635 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for | |
636 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is | |
10 | 637 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer |
638 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not | |
7 | 639 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the |
640 buffer is created. | |
641 | |
519 | 642 Hidden options *hidden-options* |
643 | |
644 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported | |
645 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces | |
646 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an | |
647 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden | |
648 option though, it is not stored. | |
649 | |
650 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: > | |
651 if exists('&foo') | |
652 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really | |
653 supported use something like this: > | |
654 if exists('+foo') | |
655 < | |
7 | 656 *E355* |
657 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|. | |
658 | |
659 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph* | |
18972 | 660 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-Windows, 224 otherwise) |
7 | 661 global |
662 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
663 feature} | |
664 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The | |
665 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode | |
666 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_) | |
667 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26]. | |
668 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8. | |
669 See |rileft.txt|. | |
670 | |
671 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'* | |
672 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off) | |
673 global | |
674 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
675 feature} | |
676 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to | |
677 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get | |
678 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See | |
679 'revins'. | |
680 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
681 | |
682 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'* | |
683 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off) | |
684 global | |
685 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi| | |
686 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
687 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
688 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 689 |
690 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'* | |
691 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single") | |
692 global | |
693 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding. | |
694 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class | |
695 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek | |
696 letters, Cyrillic letters). | |
697 | |
698 There are currently two possible values: | |
233 | 699 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is |
7 | 700 expected by most users. |
701 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters. | |
2492
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
702 *E834* *E835* |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
703 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars' |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
704 contains a character that would be double width. |
7 | 705 |
706 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for | |
707 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in | |
708 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro, | |
709 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets, | |
233 | 710 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also |
7 | 711 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text |
233 | 712 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or |
7 | 713 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font |
714 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.), | |
715 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived | |
716 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has | |
19116 | 717 to be set to "double" under CJK MS-Windows when the system locale is |
718 set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode Standard Annex #11 | |
719 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11). | |
7 | 720 |
4229 | 721 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is |
722 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the | |
12499 | 723 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can |
724 be found in |v:termu7resp|. | |
4229 | 725 |
7 | 726 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'* |
727 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off) | |
728 global | |
729 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled | |
730 on Mac OS X} | |
731 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X | |
732 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts, | |
733 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays. | |
734 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set | |
735 to its default (empty string). | |
11160 | 736 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 737 |
738 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'* | |
739 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off) | |
740 global | |
2152 | 741 {only available when compiled with it, use |
742 exists("+autochdir") to check} | |
438 | 743 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you |
744 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window. | |
745 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened | |
746 or selected. | |
819 | 747 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. |
7 | 748 |
749 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'* | |
750 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off) | |
751 local to window | |
752 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
753 feature} | |
754 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text. | |
755 Setting this option will: | |
756 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
757 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
758 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles | |
759 between typing English and Arabic key mapping. | |
760 - Set the 'delcombine' option | |
761 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text. | |
762 | |
763 Resetting this option will: | |
764 - Reset the 'rightleft' option. | |
765 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value). | |
766 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global | |
3557 | 767 option). |
11160 | 768 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 769 Also see |arabic.txt|. |
770 | |
771 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'* | |
772 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'* | |
773 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on) | |
774 global | |
775 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
776 feature} | |
777 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character | |
778 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language | |
3893 | 779 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad |
7 | 780 one which encompasses: |
781 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location | |
782 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone). | |
783 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters | |
784 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
785 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
786 form. |
7 | 787 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for |
788 further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
11160 | 789 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 790 |
791 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'* | |
792 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off) | |
793 local to buffer | |
794 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR> | |
795 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not | |
796 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type | |
1152 | 797 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor |
798 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included | |
799 in 'cpoptions'. | |
10 | 800 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you |
801 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first | |
802 line. | |
7 | 803 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in |
804 a different way. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
805 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
806 restored when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 807 |
808 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'* | |
809 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off) | |
810 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
811 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and | |
812 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
813 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
814 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
815 |timestamp| |
7 | 816 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to |
817 using the global value: > | |
818 :set autoread< | |
819 < | |
820 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'* | |
821 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off) | |
822 global | |
823 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each | |
824 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!, | |
864 | 825 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, |
7 | 826 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file. |
827 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see | |
828 'autowriteall' for that. | |
14695 | 829 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is |
14668 | 830 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt". |
7 | 831 |
832 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'* | |
833 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off) | |
834 global | |
835 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit", | |
836 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window. | |
837 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has | |
838 been set. | |
839 | |
840 *'background'* *'bg'* | |
2826 | 841 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below) |
7 | 842 global |
843 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a | |
844 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that | |
845 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal. | |
846 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used. | |
847 This will not always be correct. | |
848 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim | |
849 what the background color looks like. For changing the background | |
850 color, see |:hi-normal|. | |
851 | |
852 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for | |
10 | 853 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not |
1621 | 854 change. *g:colors_name* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
855 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set) |
7 | 856 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If |
857 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work. | |
858 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
859 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed. |
7 | 860 |
861 When setting 'background' to the default value with: > | |
862 :set background& | |
863 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly, | |
864 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value. | |
18343 | 865 If the GUI supports a dark theme, you can use the "d" flag in |
18078
5ae41d0ea397
patch 8.1.2034: dark them of GTK 3 not supported
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18068
diff
changeset
|
866 'guioptions', see 'go-d'. |
7 | 867 |
12499 | 868 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background |
11442 | 869 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and |
870 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the | |
871 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in | |
12499 | 872 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
873 be found in |v:termrbgresp|. |
11442 | 874 |
7 | 875 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be |
876 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects | |
877 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to | |
878 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read | |
879 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background | |
880 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by | |
881 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value | |
882 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on"). | |
2826 | 883 |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
884 For MS-Windows the default is "dark". |
2826 | 885 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux", |
886 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark | |
887 background. Otherwise the default is "light". | |
888 | |
12254 | 889 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the |
890 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start | |
891 with a white or black background. | |
892 | |
7 | 893 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly |
894 depending on the terminal name. Example: > | |
895 :if &term == "pcterm" | |
896 : set background=dark | |
897 :endif | |
898 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups | |
899 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER | |
900 the setting of the 'background' option. | |
901 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file | |
902 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this | |
903 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be | |
904 done with ":syntax on". | |
905 | |
906 *'backspace'* *'bs'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
907 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start" |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
908 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 909 global |
910 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert | |
911 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows | |
912 a way to backspace over something: | |
913 value effect ~ | |
914 indent allow backspacing over autoindent | |
915 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines) | |
916 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U | |
917 stop once at the start of insert. | |
918 | |
919 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used. | |
920 | |
921 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier: | |
922 value effect ~ | |
923 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible) | |
924 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol" | |
925 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start" | |
926 | |
927 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want. | |
928 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. | |
929 | |
930 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'* | |
931 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off) | |
932 global | |
933 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the | |
934 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the | |
935 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being | |
936 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is | |
937 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both | |
10 | 938 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the |
7 | 939 |backup-table| for more explanations. |
940 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. | |
941 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the | |
942 oldest version of a file. | |
943 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
944 | |
945 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'* | |
946 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto") | |
6243 | 947 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 948 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's |
949 done. This is a comma separated list of words. | |
950 | |
951 The main values are: | |
952 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one | |
953 "no" rename the file and write a new one | |
954 "auto" one of the previous, what works best | |
955 | |
956 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are: | |
957 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing | |
958 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing | |
959 | |
960 Making a copy and overwriting the original file: | |
961 - Takes extra time to copy the file. | |
962 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or | |
963 has a resource fork, all this is preserved. | |
964 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link, | |
965 not of the real file. | |
966 | |
967 Renaming the file and writing a new one: | |
968 + It's fast. | |
969 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new | |
970 file. | |
971 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link. | |
972 | |
973 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file | |
974 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and | |
1152 | 975 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a |
976 copy will be made. | |
7 | 977 |
978 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in | |
979 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they | |
980 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing | |
981 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to | |
982 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be | |
983 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or | |
984 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not | |
985 be propagated back to the original source. | |
986 *crontab* | |
987 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program | |
988 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if | |
989 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the | |
10 | 990 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an |
7 | 991 example. |
992 | |
993 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled | |
994 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and | |
995 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file | |
10 | 996 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The |
7 | 997 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this |
998 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for | |
999 others. | |
1000 | |
1001 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has | |
1002 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file | |
1003 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic) | |
1004 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't | |
1005 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly | |
1006 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but | |
1007 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will | |
1008 again not rename the file. | |
1009 | |
11160 | 1010 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
1011 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
1012 | |
7 | 1013 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'* |
1014 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
18972 | 1015 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp" |
7 | 1016 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/") |
1017 global | |
1018 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas. | |
1019 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1020 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1021 create it for you. |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1022 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is |
7 | 1023 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this. |
1024 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory | |
1025 as the edited file. | |
19116 | 1026 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put |
1027 the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The leading | |
1028 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
7 | 1029 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning). |
1030 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part | |
1031 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
1032 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
1033 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
1034 - A directory name may end in an '/'. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1035 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
15033 | 1036 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the |
1037 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This | |
1038 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1039 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1040 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1041 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1042 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 1043 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
1044 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
1045 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
1046 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
1047 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
1048 of the option is removed. | |
1049 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options. | |
1050 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: > | |
1051 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp | |
1052 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your | |
1053 home directory for this to work properly. | |
1054 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
1055 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
1056 uses another default. | |
1057 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1058 security reasons. | |
1059 | |
1060 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589* | |
1061 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_") | |
1062 global | |
1063 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the | |
1064 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids | |
1065 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might | |
1066 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with | |
1067 ".bak" that you want to keep. | |
36 | 1068 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 1069 |
26 | 1070 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre |
1071 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to | |
1072 include a timestamp. > | |
1073 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~' | |
1074 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory. | |
1075 | |
7 | 1076 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'* |
13664
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1077 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1078 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1079 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*") |
7 | 1080 global |
1081 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
1082 feature} | |
1083 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the | |
1084 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both | |
1085 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used. | |
1086 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. | |
1087 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|. | |
1088 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the | |
233 | 1089 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix. |
1152 | 1090 |
3513 | 1091 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write |
1092 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
1093 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable | |
1094 backups if you don't care about losing the file. | |
1095 | |
1152 | 1096 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use |
1097 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: > | |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1098 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*' |
1152 | 1099 |
1100 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a | |
557 | 1101 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see |
1102 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|. | |
7 | 1103 |
1104 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'* | |
1105 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600) | |
1106 global | |
1107 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
1108 feature} | |
1109 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|. | |
1110 | |
1111 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'* | |
1112 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off) | |
1113 global | |
1114 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
189 | 1115 feature} |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1116 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI. |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1117 |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1118 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1119 *'nobevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1120 'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off) |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1121 global |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1122 {only available when compiled with the |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1123 |+balloon_eval_term| feature} |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1124 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal. |
7 | 1125 |
189 | 1126 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'* |
1127 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "") | |
790 | 1128 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
189 | 1129 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| |
1130 feature} | |
782 | 1131 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used |
16610 | 1132 when 'ballooneval' or 'balloonevalterm' is on. These variables can be |
1133 used: | |
189 | 1134 |
1135 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show | |
1136 v:beval_winnr number of the window | |
9227
ecb621205ed1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/82af8710bf8d1caeeceafb1370a052cb7d92f076
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9116
diff
changeset
|
1137 v:beval_winid ID of the window |
189 | 1138 v:beval_lnum line number |
1139 v:beval_col column number (byte index) | |
1140 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer | |
1141 | |
17571 | 1142 Instead of showing a balloon, which is limited to plain text, consider |
1143 using a popup window, see |popup_beval_example|. A popup window can | |
1144 use highlighting and show a border. | |
1145 | |
189 | 1146 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! |
1147 Example: > | |
16610 | 1148 function MyBalloonExpr() |
435 | 1149 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum . |
189 | 1150 \', column ' . v:beval_col . |
1151 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) . | |
1152 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"' | |
1153 endfunction | |
1154 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr() | |
1155 set ballooneval | |
1156 < | |
17372 | 1157 Also see |balloon_show()|, it can be used if the content of the balloon |
1158 is to be fetched asynchronously. In that case evaluating | |
1159 'balloonexpr' should result in an empty string. If you get a balloon | |
1160 with only "0" you probably didn't return anything from your function. | |
11062 | 1161 |
189 | 1162 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text |
1163 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty, | |
1164 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans | |
1165 or Sun Workshop). | |
1166 | |
3682 | 1167 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
1168 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
1169 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 1170 |
1171 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
17372 | 1172 evaluating 'balloonexpr', see |textlock|. |
634 | 1173 |
446 | 1174 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: > |
435 | 1175 if has("balloon_multiline") |
714 | 1176 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the |
1177 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item | |
1178 as a string and putting "\n" in between them. | |
11160 | 1179 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
714 | 1180 |
6949 | 1181 *'belloff'* *'bo'* |
1182 'belloff' 'bo' string (default "") | |
1183 global | |
1184 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma | |
1185 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell | |
1186 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in | |
1187 insert mode to be silenced. | |
1188 | |
1189 item meaning when present ~ | |
1190 all All events. | |
1191 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an | |
1192 error. | |
1193 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or | |
1194 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1195 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or | |
1196 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. | |
1197 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or | |
1198 |i_CTRL-E|. | |
1199 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode. | |
1200 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line) | |
1201 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|). | |
1202 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|. | |
1203 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error. | |
18719 | 1204 hangul Ignored. |
6949 | 1205 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'. |
1206 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL. | |
1207 mess No output available for |g<|. | |
1208 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function. | |
1209 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|. | |
1210 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1211 shell Bell from shell output |:!|. | |
1212 spell Error happened on spell suggest. | |
1213 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available | |
1214 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting). | |
1215 | |
11160 | 1216 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should |
1217 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to | |
6949 | 1218 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the |
1219 "error" keyword. | |
1220 | |
7 | 1221 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'* |
1222 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off) | |
1223 local to buffer | |
1224 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also | |
1225 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few | |
1226 options will be changed (also when it already was on): | |
1227 'textwidth' will be set to 0 | |
1228 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0 | |
1229 'modeline' will be off | |
1230 'expandtab' will be off | |
1231 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the | |
1232 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL> | |
1233 separates lines). | |
1234 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the | |
1235 file is read without conversion. | |
1236 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is | |
1237 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g., | |
1238 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set | |
1239 'bin' again when the file has been loaded. | |
1240 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when | |
1241 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of | |
1242 saved option values. | |
1243 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument. | |
1244 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all | |
1245 files you edit. | |
1246 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if | |
1247 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to | |
1248 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See | |
1249 the 'endofline' option. | |
1250 | |
1251 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'* | |
1252 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on) | |
1253 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1254 {only for MS-DOS} |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
1255 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 1256 |
1257 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'* | |
1258 'bomb' boolean (default off) | |
1259 local to buffer | |
1260 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte | |
1261 Order Mark) is prepended to the file: | |
1262 - this option is on | |
1263 - the 'binary' option is off | |
1264 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big | |
1265 endian variants. | |
1266 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file. | |
1267 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it | |
1268 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1269 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM. |
7 | 1270 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a |
1271 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly. | |
1272 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you | |
1273 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM | |
1274 will be restored when writing the file. | |
1275 | |
1276 *'breakat'* *'brk'* | |
1277 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?") | |
1278 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1279 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 1280 feature} |
1281 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line | |
500 | 1282 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit |
1283 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding. | |
7 | 1284 |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1285 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'* |
6009 | 1286 'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off) |
1287 local to window | |
1288 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1289 feature} | |
1290 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of | |
1291 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks | |
1292 of text. | |
11160 | 1293 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6009 | 1294 |
1295 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'* | |
1296 'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty) | |
1297 local to window | |
1298 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1299 feature} | |
1300 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional | |
6026 | 1301 items and must be separated by a comma: |
6009 | 1302 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after |
1303 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting | |
1304 text should normally be narrower. This prevents | |
1305 text indented almost to the right window border | |
1306 occupying lot of vertical space when broken. | |
6026 | 1307 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's |
1308 beginning will be shifted by the given number of | |
1309 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph | |
6009 | 1310 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line |
1311 continuation (positive). | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1312 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the |
6009 | 1313 additional indent. |
1314 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0. | |
1315 | |
7 | 1316 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'* |
29 | 1317 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last") |
7 | 1318 global |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1319 {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI} |
7 | 1320 Which directory to use for the file browser: |
1621 | 1321 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
1322 file was opened or saved. |
7 | 1323 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer. |
1324 current Use the current directory. | |
1325 {path} Use the specified directory | |
1326 | |
1327 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'* | |
1328 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "") | |
1329 local to buffer | |
1330 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer | |
1331 displayed in a window: | |
1332 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option | |
1333 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden' | |
1334 is not set | |
1335 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using | |
1336 |:hide| | |
1337 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1338 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1339 |:bdelete| | |
1340 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1341 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1342 |:bwipeout| | |
1343 | |
82 | 1344 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer |
3224 | 1345 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands |
1346 that switch between buffers temporarily. | |
7 | 1347 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify |
1348 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1349 | |
1350 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85* | |
1351 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on) | |
1352 local to buffer | |
1353 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If | |
1354 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc. | |
1355 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember | |
1356 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer. | |
1357 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer". | |
1358 | |
1359 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382* | |
1360 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "") | |
1361 local to buffer | |
1362 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer: | |
1363 <empty> normal buffer | |
1364 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be | |
1365 written | |
1366 nowrite buffer which will not be written | |
17 | 1367 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd |
13437 | 1368 autocommands. |
7 | 1369 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow| |
648 | 1370 or list of locations |:lwindow| |
7 | 1371 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this |
1372 manually) | |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1373 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1374 this manually) |
14019
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1375 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1376 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer| |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1377 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature} |
16778
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
1378 popup buffer used in a popup window, see |popup|. |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
1379 {only when compiled with the |+textprop| feature} |
7 | 1380 |
1381 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to | |
1382 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1383 | |
1384 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects! | |
1385 | |
648 | 1386 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location |
1387 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and | |
1388 you are not supposed to change it. | |
7 | 1389 |
1390 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar: | |
1391 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't | |
1392 work (":w filename" does work though). | |
1393 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|. | |
1394 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for | |
1395 example when you quit Vim. | |
1396 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory | |
1397 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap | |
1398 file). | |
1399 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a | |
1400 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd| | |
1401 command. | |
6647 | 1402 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname" |
1403 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are | |
1404 triggered as usual for |:edit|. | |
17 | 1405 *E676* |
1406 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like | |
1407 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and | |
1408 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned | |
1409 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|, | |
1410 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands. | |
7 | 1411 |
1412 *'casemap'* *'cmp'* | |
1413 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii") | |
1414 global | |
1415 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain | |
1416 these words, separated by a comma: | |
1417 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current | |
1418 locale does not change the case mapping. This only | |
493 | 1419 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding, |
1420 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is | |
1421 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library | |
1422 functions are used when available. | |
7 | 1423 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US |
1424 case mapping, the current locale is not effective. | |
1425 This probably only matters for Turkish. | |
1426 | |
1427 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346* | |
1428 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,") | |
1429 global | |
1430 {not available when compiled without the | |
1431 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
1432 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
16427
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1433 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1434 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1435 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then. |
7 | 1436 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as |
1437 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|. | |
1438 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look | |
1439 in the current directory first. | |
1440 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include | |
1441 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to | |
1442 override it: > | |
1443 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g') | |
1444 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1445 security reasons. | |
1446 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names). | |
1447 | |
1448 *'cedit'* | |
1449 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F) | |
1450 global | |
1451 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window. | |
1452 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off. | |
1453 Only non-printable keys are allowed. | |
1454 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to | |
1455 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: > | |
9407
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1456 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>" |
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1457 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>" |
7 | 1458 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character. |
1459 See |cmdwin|. | |
11160 | 1460 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
1461 is reset. | |
7 | 1462 |
1463 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513* | |
1464 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "") | |
1465 global | |
15878 | 1466 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 1467 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is |
1468 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a | |
1469 different encoding from what is desired. | |
1470 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is | |
1471 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is | |
1472 preferred, because it is much faster. | |
1473 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no | |
1474 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first. | |
1475 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success, | |
1476 non-zero for failure. | |
1477 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'. | |
1478 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are | |
1479 used. | |
1480 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8" | |
1481 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this. | |
1482 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c' | |
1483 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion. | |
1484 Example: > | |
1485 set charconvert=CharConvert() | |
1486 fun CharConvert() | |
1487 system("recode " | |
1488 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to | |
1489 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out) | |
1490 return v:shell_error | |
1491 endfun | |
1492 < The related Vim variables are: | |
1493 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding | |
1494 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding | |
1495 v:fname_in name of the input file | |
1496 v:fname_out name of the output file | |
1497 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same. | |
1498 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different | |
1499 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4. | |
1500 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want | |
1501 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care | |
1502 of this. | |
1503 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1504 security reasons. | |
1505 | |
1506 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'* | |
1507 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off) | |
1508 local to buffer | |
1509 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1510 feature} | |
1621 | 1511 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys |
7 | 1512 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your |
1513 preferred indent style. | |
1514 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'. | |
1515 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty, | |
1516 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an | |
1517 external program. | |
1518 See |C-indenting|. | |
1519 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent' | |
1520 option or 'indentexpr'. | |
1521 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
1522 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
1523 | |
1524 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'* | |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
1525 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 1526 local to buffer |
1527 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1528 feature} | |
1529 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
1530 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is | |
1531 empty. | |
1532 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|. | |
1533 See |C-indenting|. | |
1534 | |
1535 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'* | |
1536 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "") | |
1537 local to buffer | |
1538 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1539 feature} | |
1540 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C | |
1541 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and | |
1542 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general. | |
1543 | |
1544 | |
1545 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'* | |
1546 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch") | |
1547 local to buffer | |
1548 {not available when compiled without both the | |
1549 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features} | |
1550 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when | |
1551 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at | |
1552 an appropriate place (inside {}). | |
1553 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't | |
1554 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase: | |
1555 "if,If,IF". | |
1556 | |
1557 *'clipboard'* *'cb'* | |
1558 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux" | |
1559 for X-windows, "" otherwise) | |
1560 global | |
1561 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard| | |
1562 feature is included} | |
1563 This option is a list of comma separated names. | |
1564 These names are recognized: | |
1565 | |
3674 | 1566 *clipboard-unnamed* |
7 | 1567 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*' |
1568 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which | |
1569 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a | |
1570 register is explicitly specified, it will always be | |
1571 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard' | |
1572 or not. The clipboard register can always be | |
1573 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see | |
1574 |gui-clipboard|. | |
1575 | |
3682 | 1576 *clipboard-unnamedplus* |
4119 | 1577 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the |
1578 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of | |
1579 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put | |
1580 operations which would normally go to the unnamed | |
1581 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the | |
1582 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or | |
1583 put) will additionally copy the text into register | |
1584 '*'. | |
2662 | 1585 Only available with the |+X11| feature. |
2654 | 1586 Availability can be checked with: > |
1587 if has('unnamedplus') | |
1588 < | |
3682 | 1589 *clipboard-autoselect* |
7 | 1590 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present, |
1591 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual | |
1592 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the | |
1593 windowing system's global selection or put the | |
1594 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection | |
14999 | 1595 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details. |
1596 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions' | |
1597 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect" | |
1598 flag is used. | |
7 | 1599 Also applies to the modeless selection. |
1600 | |
3674 | 1601 *clipboard-autoselectplus* |
1602 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of | |
1603 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in | |
1604 'guioptions'. | |
1605 | |
1606 *clipboard-autoselectml* | |
7 | 1607 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection |
1608 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1609 | |
3674 | 1610 *clipboard-html* |
1904 | 1611 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when |
1612 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it | |
1613 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from | |
1614 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML | |
1615 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox. | |
2240
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1616 You probably want to add this only temporarily, |
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1617 possibly use BufEnter autocommands. |
1904 | 1618 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later. |
1619 | |
3674 | 1620 *clipboard-exclude* |
7 | 1621 exclude:{pattern} |
1622 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of | |
1623 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no | |
1624 connection will be made to the X server. This is | |
1625 useful in this situation: | |
1626 - Running Vim in a console. | |
1627 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another | |
1628 display. | |
1629 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the | |
1630 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator. | |
1631 To never connect to the X server use: > | |
1632 exclude:.* | |
1633 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument. | |
1634 Note that when there is no connection to the X server | |
1635 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard | |
1636 cannot be accessed. | |
1637 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is | |
1638 interpreted as if 'magic' was on. | |
1639 The rest of the option value will be used for | |
1640 {pattern}, this must be the last entry. | |
1641 | |
1642 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'* | |
1643 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1) | |
1644 global | |
1645 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding | |
1646 |hit-enter| prompts. | |
824 | 1647 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab |
1648 page can have a different value. | |
7 | 1649 |
1650 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'* | |
1651 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7) | |
1652 global | |
1653 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin| | |
1654 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1655 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'* |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1656 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "") |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1657 local to window |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1658 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1659 feature} |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1660 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1661 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1662 text. Will make screen redrawing slower. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1663 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1664 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. > |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1665 |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1666 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1667 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1668 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1669 < |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1670 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1671 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1672 |
7 | 1673 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594* |
1674 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width) | |
1675 global | |
1676 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal | |
161 | 1677 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see |
1678 |posix-screen-size|. | |
7 | 1679 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
1680 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
1681 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
1682 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical | |
1152 | 1683 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For |
1684 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to | |
1685 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest | |
1686 window possible: > | |
1687 :set columns=9999 | |
1688 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000. | |
7 | 1689 |
1690 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525* | |
1691 'comments' 'com' string (default | |
1692 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-") | |
1693 local to buffer | |
1694 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See | |
1695 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to | |
1696 insert a space. | |
1697 | |
1698 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537* | |
1699 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/") | |
1700 local to buffer | |
1701 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
1702 feature} | |
1703 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the | |
1704 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see | |
1705 |fold-marker|. | |
1706 | |
1707 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'* | |
819 | 1708 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
1709 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 1710 global |
1711 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or | |
1712 make Vim behave in a more useful way. | |
11062 | 1713 |
7 | 1714 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset, |
11062 | 1715 other options are also changed as a side effect. |
1716 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected | |
1717 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves | |
1718 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you | |
1719 should probably put it at the very start. | |
1720 | |
7 | 1721 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the |
1722 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim | |
1723 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible' | |
1724 option. | |
819 | 1725 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up, |
378 | 1726 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been |
1727 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means | |
819 | 1728 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim |
378 | 1729 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't |
1152 | 1730 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given |
1731 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and | |
1732 |posix-compliance|. | |
7 | 1733 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with |
1734 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|. | |
11062 | 1735 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility. |
1736 | |
1737 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as | |
1738 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options | |
1739 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the | |
1740 options affected. | |
1741 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected: | |
1742 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1743 'compatible' is set. | |
1744 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1745 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when | |
1746 'compatible' is unset. | |
1747 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS | |
1748 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset. | |
1749 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set. | |
1750 | |
11160 | 1751 option ? set value effect ~ |
11062 | 1752 |
1753 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command | |
1754 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts | |
1755 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options | |
1756 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes | |
1757 'backspace' + "" normal backspace | |
1758 'backup' + off no backup file | |
1759 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy | |
1760 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file | |
1761 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon | |
1762 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines | |
1763 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1764 'cindent' + off no C code indentation | |
1765 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1766 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure | |
1767 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags | |
1768 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1769 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix |
11062 | 1770 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag" |
11160 | 1771 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder| |
11062 | 1772 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose| |
1773 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination | |
1774 'digraph' + off no digraphs | |
1775 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode | |
1776 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces | |
1777 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection, | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
1778 "dos,unix" except for MS-Windows |
11062 | 1779 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting |
1780 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting | |
1781 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s" | |
1782 'history' & 0 no commandline history | |
1783 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1784 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1785 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches | |
1786 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching | |
1787 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression | |
1788 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode | |
1789 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric | |
7 | 1790 characters and '_' |
11062 | 1791 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period |
1792 'modeline' & off no modelines | |
1793 'more' & off no pauses in listings | |
1794 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1795 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number | |
1796 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure | |
1797 when changing it | |
1798 'revins' + off no reverse insert | |
1799 'ruler' + off no ruler | |
1800 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll | |
1801 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset | |
1802 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1803 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth | |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
1804 'shortmess' & "S" no shortening of messages |
11062 | 1805 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown |
1806 'showmode' & off current mode not shown | |
1807 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll | |
1808 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch | |
1809 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation | |
1810 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size | |
1811 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions | |
1812 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands | |
1813 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file | |
1814 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative | |
1815 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg) | |
1816 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection | |
1817 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap | |
1818 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator | |
1819 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout | |
1820 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file | |
11160 | 1821 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'} |
11062 | 1822 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters |
1823 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap | |
1824 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab> | |
7 | 1825 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion |
11062 | 1826 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature |
7 | 1827 |
1828 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535* | |
1829 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i") | |
1830 local to buffer | |
1831 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works | |
1832 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line | |
1833 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion | |
1834 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags: | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1835 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored) |
7 | 1836 w scan buffers from other windows |
1837 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1838 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1839 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list | |
1840 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option | |
703 | 1841 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell| |
7 | 1842 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given, |
1843 patterns are valid too. For example: > | |
1844 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish | |
1845 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option | |
1846 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns | |
1847 are valid too. | |
1848 i scan current and included files | |
1849 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro | |
1850 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D| | |
1851 ] tag completion | |
1852 t same as "]" | |
1853 | |
1854 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are | |
1855 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files | |
1856 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for | |
1857 whole-line completion. | |
1858 | |
1859 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan: | |
1860 1. the current buffer | |
1861 2. buffers in other windows | |
1862 3. other loaded buffers | |
1863 4. unloaded buffers | |
1864 5. tags | |
1865 6. included files | |
1866 | |
1867 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'- | |
233 | 1868 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns |
1869 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions). | |
7 | 1870 |
12 | 1871 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'* |
1872 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty) | |
1873 local to buffer | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1874 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
17809
59f8948b7590
patch 8.1.1901: the +insert_expand feature is not always available
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17771
diff
changeset
|
1875 feature} |
623 | 1876 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion |
1877 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U| | |
648 | 1878 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
1879 invoked and what it should return. | |
2642 | 1880 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
1881 security reasons. | |
14 | 1882 |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1883 *'completeslash'* *'csl'* |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1884 'completeslash' 'csl' string (default: "") |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1885 local to buffer |
18343 | 1886 {only for MS-Windows} |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1887 When this option is set it overrules 'shellslash' for completion: |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1888 - When this option is set to "slash", a forward slash is used for path |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1889 completion in insert mode. This is useful when editing HTML tag, or |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
1890 Makefile with 'noshellslash' on MS-Windows. |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1891 - When this option is set to "backslash", backslash is used. This is |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
1892 useful when editing a batch file with 'shellslash' set on MS-Windows. |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1893 - When this option is empty, same character is used as for |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1894 'shellslash'. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1895 For Insert mode completion the buffer-local value is used. For |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1896 command line completion the global value is used. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1897 |
540 | 1898 *'completeopt'* *'cot'* |
730 | 1899 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview") |
540 | 1900 global |
665 | 1901 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion |
1902 |ins-completion|. The supported values are: | |
540 | 1903 |
1904 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The | |
1905 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and | |
1906 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu| | |
1907 | |
707 | 1908 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match. |
856 | 1909 Useful when there is additional information about the |
707 | 1910 match, e.g., what file it comes from. |
1911 | |
836 | 1912 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If |
1913 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more | |
1914 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind | |
1915 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is | |
1916 used. | |
665 | 1917 |
730 | 1918 preview Show extra information about the currently selected |
1152 | 1919 completion in the preview window. Only works in |
1920 combination with "menu" or "menuone". | |
1921 | |
17767
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
1922 popup Show extra information about the currently selected |
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
1923 completion in a popup window. Only works in combination |
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
1924 with "menu" or "menuone". Overrides "preview". |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1925 See |'completepopup'| for specifying properties. |
18343 | 1926 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature} |
17767
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
1927 |
18396
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1928 popuphidden |
18719 | 1929 Just like "popup" but initially hide the popup. Use a |
18396
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1930 |CompleteChanged| autocommand to fetch the info and call |
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1931 |popup_show()| once the popup has been filled. |
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1932 See the example at |complete-popuphidden|. |
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1933 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature} |
ba5d8c5d77d7
patch 8.1.2192: cannot easily fill the info popup asynchronously
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18372
diff
changeset
|
1934 |
6911 | 1935 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects |
1936 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1937 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present. | |
1938 | |
1939 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to | |
1940 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1941 "menu" or "menuone". | |
1942 | |
730 | 1943 |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1944 *'completepopup'* *'cpp'* |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1945 'completepopup' 'cpp' string (default empty) |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1946 global |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1947 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop| |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1948 or |+quickfix| feature} |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1949 When 'completeopt' contains "popup" then this option is used for the |
17909 | 1950 properties of the info popup when it is created. You can also use |
1951 |popup_findinfo()| and then set properties for an existing info popup | |
1952 with |popup_setoptions()|. See |complete-popup|. | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1953 |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
1954 |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1955 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'* |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1956 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "") |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1957 local to window |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1958 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1959 feature} |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1960 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1961 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1962 other lines. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1963 n Normal mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1964 v Visual mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1965 i Insert mode |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1966 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch' |
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1967 |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2394
diff
changeset
|
1968 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor. |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1969 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1970 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1971 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1972 you can see what you are doing. |
2380
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1973 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's |
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1974 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column. |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1975 |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1976 |
14864 | 1977 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'* |
1978 'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0) | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1979 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1980 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1981 feature} |
2340
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1982 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal| |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1983 is shown: |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1984 |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1985 Value Effect ~ |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1986 0 Text is shown normally |
2426 | 1987 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one |
1988 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom | |
1989 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the | |
1990 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a | |
1991 space). | |
1992 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group. | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1993 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1994 custom replacement character defined (see |
2426 | 1995 |:syn-cchar|). |
2349
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1996 3 Concealed text is completely hidden. |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1997 |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1998 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1999 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor' |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
2000 option. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2001 |
7 | 2002 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'* |
2003 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off) | |
2004 global | |
2005 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally | |
2006 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e", | |
2007 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current | |
2008 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer. | |
2009 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one | |
2010 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm| | |
2011 command. | |
2012 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
2013 | |
2014 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'* | |
2015 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off) | |
2016 global | |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
2017 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 2018 |
2019 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'* | |
2020 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off) | |
2021 local to buffer | |
2022 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a | |
2023 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of | |
2024 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled, | |
2025 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the | |
2026 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the | |
1621 | 2027 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab |
2028 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing | |
7 | 2029 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner. |
11160 | 2030 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2031 Also see 'preserveindent'. |
2032 | |
8148
f5da459c5698
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e0fa3742ead676a3074a10edadbc955e1a89153d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8061
diff
changeset
|
2033 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo* |
7 | 2034 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs", |
2035 Vi default: all flags) | |
2036 global | |
2037 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present | |
5340 | 2038 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where |
2039 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred. | |
7 | 2040 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options". |
2041 Commas can be added for readability. | |
2042 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
2043 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
2044 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2045 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
164 | 2046 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when |
2047 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2048 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2049 POSIX specification. |
7 | 2050 |
2051 contains behavior ~ | |
2052 *cpo-a* | |
2053 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2054 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2055 current window. | |
2056 *cpo-A* | |
2057 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2058 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2059 current window. | |
2060 *cpo-b* | |
2061 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of | |
2062 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping, | |
2063 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next | |
2064 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to | |
2065 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all | |
2066 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands. | |
2067 See also |map_bar|. | |
2068 *cpo-B* | |
2069 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings, | |
14372 | 2070 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the |
2071 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a | |
2072 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command | |
2073 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to: | |
7 | 2074 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>) |
2075 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters) | |
2076 ('<' excluded in both cases) | |
2077 *cpo-c* | |
2078 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the | |
2079 cursor position, but not further than the start of the | |
2080 next line. When not present searching continues | |
2081 one character from the cursor position. With 'c' | |
2082 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating | |
2083 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches. | |
2084 *cpo-C* | |
2085 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a | |
2086 backslash. See |line-continuation|. | |
2087 *cpo-d* | |
2088 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use | |
2089 the tags file relative to the current file, but the | |
2090 tags file in the current directory. | |
2091 *cpo-D* | |
2092 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode | |
2093 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and | |
2094 |t|. | |
2095 *cpo-e* | |
2096 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a | |
2097 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not | |
2098 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register | |
2099 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a | |
2100 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line | |
2101 and can be edited before hitting <CR>. | |
2102 *cpo-E* | |
2103 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or | |
2104 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
2105 at least one character is to be operated on. Example: |
7 | 2106 This makes "y0" fail in the first column. |
2107 *cpo-f* | |
2108 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2109 argument will set the file name for the current buffer, | |
2110 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet. | |
2111 *cpo-F* | |
2112 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2113 argument will set the file name for the current | |
2114 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name | |
590 | 2115 yet. Also see |cpo-P|. |
7 | 2116 *cpo-g* |
2117 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument. | |
164 | 2118 *cpo-H* |
2119 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert | |
2120 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after | |
2121 the last blank. | |
7 | 2122 *cpo-i* |
2123 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will | |
2124 leave it modified. | |
10 | 2125 *cpo-I* |
2126 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting | |
2127 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent. | |
7 | 2128 *cpo-j* |
2129 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.', | |
2130 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'. | |
2131 *cpo-J* | |
2132 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after | |
233 | 2133 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as |
7 | 2134 white space. |
2135 *cpo-k* | |
2136 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in | |
2137 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu | |
2138 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[ | |
2139 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X | |
2140 being mapped to: | |
2141 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters) | |
2142 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code) | |
2143 Also see the '<' flag below. | |
2144 *cpo-K* | |
2145 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is | |
2146 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when | |
2147 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It | |
2148 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>. | |
2149 *cpo-l* | |
2150 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
168 | 2151 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special. |
2152 See |/[]| | |
7 | 2153 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't' |
2154 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab> | |
168 | 2155 Also see |cpo-\|. |
7 | 2156 *cpo-L* |
2157 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin', | |
2158 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode | |
2159 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of | |
2160 the normal behavior of a <Tab>. | |
2161 *cpo-m* | |
2162 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a | |
2163 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half | |
2164 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'| | |
2165 *cpo-M* | |
2166 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into | |
2167 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer | |
2168 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores | |
2169 backslashes, which is Vi compatible. | |
2170 *cpo-n* | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2171 n When included, the column used for 'number' and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2172 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2173 lines. |
7 | 2174 *cpo-o* |
2175 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for | |
2176 next search. | |
2177 *cpo-O* | |
2178 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even | |
2179 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a | |
2180 protection against a file unexpectedly created by | |
2181 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this. | |
2182 *cpo-p* | |
2183 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a | |
2184 slightly better algorithm is used. | |
590 | 2185 *cpo-P* |
2186 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a | |
2187 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if | |
2188 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and | |
2189 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|. | |
164 | 2190 *cpo-q* |
2191 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the | |
2192 position where it would be when joining two lines. | |
7 | 2193 *cpo-r* |
2194 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search | |
2195 command, instead of the actually used search string. | |
2196 *cpo-R* | |
2197 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag | |
2198 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used. | |
2199 *cpo-s* | |
2200 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the | |
2201 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0. | |
10 | 2202 And it is the default. If not present the options are |
7 | 2203 set when the buffer is created. |
2204 *cpo-S* | |
2205 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer | |
2206 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and | |
2207 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting. | |
2208 The options are set to the values in the current | |
2209 buffer. When you change an option and go to another | |
2210 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the | |
2211 buffer options global to all buffers. | |
2212 | |
2213 's' 'S' copy buffer options | |
2214 no no when buffer created | |
2215 yes no when buffer first entered (default) | |
2216 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.) | |
2217 *cpo-t* | |
2218 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for | |
2219 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in | |
2220 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the | |
2221 last used search pattern. | |
2222 *cpo-u* | |
10 | 2223 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|. |
7 | 2224 *cpo-v* |
2225 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in | |
2226 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are | |
2227 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the | |
2228 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced | |
2229 characters. | |
2230 *cpo-w* | |
2231 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one | |
2232 character and not all blanks until the start of the | |
2233 next word. | |
2234 *cpo-W* | |
2235 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!" | |
2236 overwrites a readonly file, if possible. | |
2237 *cpo-x* | |
2238 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line. | |
2239 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line, | |
2240 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>| | |
164 | 2241 *cpo-X* |
2242 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is | |
2243 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "." | |
2244 and a count. | |
7 | 2245 *cpo-y* |
15512 | 2246 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if |
2247 you really want to use this, it may break some | |
2248 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a | |
2249 change. | |
164 | 2250 *cpo-Z* |
2251 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set, | |
2252 don't reset 'readonly'. | |
7 | 2253 *cpo-!* |
2254 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used | |
2255 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last | |
2256 used -filter- command is used. | |
2257 *cpo-$* | |
2258 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the | |
2259 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text. | |
2260 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the | |
2261 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any | |
2262 command that moves the cursor from the insertion | |
2263 point. | |
2264 *cpo-%* | |
2265 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command. | |
2266 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc. | |
2267 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/". | |
2268 Parens inside single and double quotes are also | |
2269 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to | |
2270 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like | |
2271 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not | |
2272 match the last one. When this flag is not included, | |
2273 parens inside single and double quotes are treated | |
2274 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes, | |
2275 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a | |
2276 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if | |
10 | 2277 there is one). This works very well for C programs. |
36 | 2278 This flag is also used for other features, such as |
2279 C-indenting. | |
161 | 2280 *cpo--* |
2281 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when | |
632 | 2282 it would go above the first line or below the last |
2283 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or | |
2284 last line, unless it already was in that line. | |
161 | 2285 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j", |
632 | 2286 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234". |
39 | 2287 *cpo-+* |
2288 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the | |
2289 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer | |
2290 itself may still be different from its file. | |
856 | 2291 *cpo-star* |
7 | 2292 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included, |
2293 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area. | |
2294 *cpo-<* | |
2295 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>| | |
2296 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of | |
10 | 2297 menu commands. For example, the command |
7 | 2298 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to: |
2299 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters) | |
2300 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>) | |
2301 Also see the 'k' flag above. | |
164 | 2302 *cpo->* |
2303 > When appending to a register, put a line break before | |
2304 the appended text. | |
2925 | 2305 *cpo-;* |
2306 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search | |
2307 and the cursor is right in front of the searched | |
2308 character, the cursor won't move. When not included, | |
2309 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the | |
3557 | 2310 following occurrence. |
164 | 2311 |
2312 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except | |
2313 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix| | |
2314 | |
2315 contains behavior ~ | |
856 | 2316 *cpo-#* |
164 | 2317 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect. |
168 | 2318 *cpo-&* |
2319 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when | |
2320 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded. | |
2321 This flag is tested when exiting. | |
2322 *cpo-\* | |
2323 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
2324 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]| | |
488 | 2325 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-' |
2326 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-' | |
2327 Also see |cpo-l|. | |
168 | 2328 *cpo-/* |
2329 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s| | |
2330 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%| | |
164 | 2331 *cpo-{* |
2332 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character | |
2333 at the start of a line. | |
168 | 2334 *cpo-.* |
2335 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current | |
2336 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't | |
2337 need this, since it remembers the full path of an | |
2338 opened file. | |
164 | 2339 *cpo-bar* |
2340 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment | |
2341 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained | |
2342 with system specific functions. | |
2343 | |
7 | 2344 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2345 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'* |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2346 'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2") |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2347 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2348 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file: |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2349 *pkzip* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2350 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption. |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2351 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older. |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2352 *blowfish* |
6122 | 2353 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has |
2354 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later, | |
2355 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds | |
2356 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file | |
2357 the encrypted bytes will be different. | |
2358 *blowfish2* | |
2359 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
2360 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3 |
6122 | 2361 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time |
2362 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be | |
2363 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just | |
2364 the pieces of text. | |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2365 |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2366 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files. |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2367 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2368 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2369 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2370 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2371 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2372 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2373 modifications. Also see |:X|. |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2374 |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2375 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2376 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty |
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2377 string the buffer will use the global value. |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2378 |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2379 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2380 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* . |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2381 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2382 |
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2383 |
7 | 2384 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'* |
2385 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0) | |
2386 global | |
2387 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2388 feature} | |
2389 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags. | |
2390 See |cscopepathcomp|. | |
11160 | 2391 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2392 |
2393 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'* | |
2394 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope") | |
2395 global | |
2396 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2397 feature} | |
2398 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|. | |
2399 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2400 security reasons. | |
2401 | |
2402 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'* | |
2403 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "") | |
2404 global | |
2405 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2406 or |+quickfix| features} | |
2407 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results. | |
2408 See |cscopequickfix|. | |
2409 | |
4869 | 2410 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'* |
2873 | 2411 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off) |
2412 global | |
2413 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2414 feature} | |
2415 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables | |
2416 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix. | |
2417 See |cscoperelative|. | |
11160 | 2418 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2873 | 2419 |
7 | 2420 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'* |
2421 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off) | |
2422 global | |
2423 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2424 feature} | |
2425 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|. | |
2426 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2427 | |
2428 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'* | |
2429 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0) | |
2430 global | |
2431 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2432 feature} | |
2433 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See | |
2434 |cscopetagorder|. | |
2435 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
2436 | |
2437 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'* | |
2438 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'* | |
2439 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off) | |
2440 global | |
2441 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2442 feature} | |
2443 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|. | |
2444 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2445 | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2446 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'* |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2447 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off) |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2448 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2449 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2450 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2451 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2452 column. This option is useful for viewing the |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2453 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode, |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2454 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
2455 taken into account. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2456 |
743 | 2457 |
2458 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'* | |
2459 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off) | |
2460 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2461 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2462 feature} |
2463 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn | |
2464 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing | |
2465 slower. | |
826 | 2466 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use |
2467 these autocommands: > | |
2468 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn | |
2469 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn | |
2470 < | |
743 | 2471 |
2472 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'* | |
2473 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off) | |
2474 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2475 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2476 feature} |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2477 Highlight the text line of the cursor with CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|. |
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2478 Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen redrawing slower. |
818 | 2479 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it |
825 | 2480 easier to see the selected text. |
743 | 2481 |
2482 | |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2483 *'cursorlineopt'* *'culopt'* |
18068
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2484 'cursorlineopt' 'culopt' string (default: "number,line") |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2485 local to window |
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2486 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2487 feature} |
18068
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2488 Comma separated list of settings for how 'cursorline' is displayed. |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2489 Valid values: |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2490 "line" Highlight the text line of the cursor with |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2491 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|. |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2492 "screenline" Highlight only the screen line of the cursor with |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2493 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|. |
18068
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2494 "number" Highlight the line number of the cursor with |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2495 CursorLineNr |hl-CursorLineNr|. |
18068
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2496 |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2497 Special value: |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2498 "both" Alias for the values "line,number". |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2499 |
1101eacc1444
patch 8.1.2029: cannot control 'cursorline' highlighting well
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18053
diff
changeset
|
2500 "line" and "screenline" cannot be used together. |
18047
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2501 |
6650e3dff8d4
patch 8.1.2019: 'cursorline' always highlights the whole line
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17909
diff
changeset
|
2502 |
7 | 2503 *'debug'* |
2504 'debug' string (default "") | |
2505 global | |
839 | 2506 These values can be used: |
2507 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2508 anyway. | |
2509 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2510 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|. | |
2511 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be | |
2512 produced. | |
168 | 2513 The values can be combined, separated by a comma. |
839 | 2514 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or |
2515 'indentexpr'. | |
7 | 2516 |
2517 *'define'* *'def'* | |
2518 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define") | |
2519 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
10 | 2520 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search |
7 | 2521 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the |
2522 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is | |
2523 used to recognize the defined name after the match: | |
2524 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char} | |
2525 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space | |
2526 or backslash. | |
2527 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be | |
2528 useful, to include const type declarations: > | |
2529 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\) | |
16086 | 2530 < You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern |
2531 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is | |
2532 defined with "func_name = function(args)": > | |
2533 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function( | |
2534 < If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": > | |
2535 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*( | |
7 | 2536 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes! |
16086 | 2537 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: > |
2538 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function(' | |
16380 | 2539 < |
7 | 2540 |
2541 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'* | |
2542 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off) | |
2543 global | |
2544 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode | |
2545 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the | |
2546 default) the character along with its combining characters are | |
2547 deleted. | |
2548 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"! | |
2549 | |
2550 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one | |
2551 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want | |
2552 to remove only the combining ones. | |
11160 | 2553 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2554 |
2555 *'dictionary'* *'dict'* | |
2556 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "") | |
2557 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2558 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
2559 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should | |
2560 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several | |
2561 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is | |
2562 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
13950
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2563 |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2564 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2565 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2566 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|. |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2567 |
10 | 2568 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 2569 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
2570 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
99 | 2571 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type. |
7 | 2572 Where to find a list of words? |
2573 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words". | |
2574 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory. | |
2575 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection. | |
2576 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2577 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2578 uses another default. | |
2579 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
2580 | |
2581 *'diff'* *'nodiff'* | |
2582 'diff' boolean (default off) | |
2583 local to window | |
2584 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2585 feature} | |
2586 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences | |
10 | 2587 between files. See |vimdiff|. |
7 | 2588 |
2589 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'* | |
2590 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "") | |
2591 global | |
2592 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2593 feature} | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2594 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2595 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|. |
7 | 2596 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2597 security reasons. | |
2598 | |
2599 *'dip'* *'diffopt'* | |
18590
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2600 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "internal,filler,closeoff") |
7 | 2601 global |
2602 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2603 feature} | |
10 | 2604 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items. |
7 | 2605 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma. |
2606 | |
2607 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text | |
2608 synchronized with a window that has inserted | |
2609 lines at the same position. Mostly useful | |
2610 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind' | |
2611 is set. | |
2612 | |
2613 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change | |
2614 and a fold that contains unchanged lines. | |
2615 When omitted a context of six lines is used. | |
15932 | 2616 When using zero the context is actually one, |
2617 since folds require a line in between, also | |
2618 for a deleted line. | |
7 | 2619 See |fold-diff|. |
2620 | |
14864 | 2621 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds |
2622 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2623 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2624 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2625 exactly. | |
2626 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync, | |
2627 because no differences between blank lines are | |
2628 taken into account. | |
2629 | |
7 | 2630 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A" |
2631 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag | |
2632 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty. | |
2633 | |
2634 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds | |
2635 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2636 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2637 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2638 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing | |
2639 white space, but not leading white space. | |
2640 | |
14864 | 2641 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds |
2642 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2643 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2644 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2645 exactly. | |
2646 | |
2647 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line. | |
2648 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2649 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2650 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2651 exactly. | |
2652 | |
766 | 2653 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless |
2654 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2655 | |
2656 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless | |
2657 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2658 | |
18590
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2659 closeoff When a window is closed where 'diff' is set |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2660 and there is only one window remaining in the |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2661 same tab page with 'diff' set, execute |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2662 `:diffoff` in that window. This undoes a |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2663 `:diffsplit` command. |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2664 |
12971
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2665 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2666 becomes hidden. |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2667 |
766 | 2668 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when |
2669 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used. | |
2670 | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2671 internal Use the internal diff library. This is |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2672 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960* |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2673 When running out of memory when writing a |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2674 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2675 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose' |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2676 option to see when this happens. |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2677 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2678 indent-heuristic |
15033 | 2679 Use the indent heuristic for the internal |
2680 diff library. | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2681 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2682 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the |
15033 | 2683 internal diff engine. Currently supported |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2684 algorithms are: |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2685 myers the default algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2686 minimal spend extra time to generate the |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2687 smallest possible diff |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2688 patience patience diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2689 histogram histogram diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2690 |
7 | 2691 Examples: > |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2692 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4 |
7 | 2693 :set diffopt= |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2694 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2695 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser |
7 | 2696 < |
2697 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'* | |
2698 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off) | |
2699 global | |
2700 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs| | |
2701 feature} | |
2702 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS> | |
2703 {char2}. See |digraphs|. | |
2704 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2705 | |
2706 *'directory'* *'dir'* | |
2707 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
18972 | 2708 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp" |
7 | 2709 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp") |
2710 global | |
2711 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas. | |
2712 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is | |
2713 possible. | |
2714 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is | |
18372
11394af51615
patch 8.1.2180: Error E303 is not useful when 'directory' is empty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18343
diff
changeset
|
2715 impossible!) and no |E303| error will be given. |
7 | 2716 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as |
2717 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so | |
2718 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden" | |
2719 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible. | |
19116 | 2720 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put |
2721 the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading "." | |
2722 is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2723 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2724 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2725 with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs. This will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2726 ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory. |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2727 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2728 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2729 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2730 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 2731 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part |
2732 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
2733 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
2734 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
2735 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'. | |
2736 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2737 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
2738 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
2739 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
2740 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
2741 of the option is removed. | |
2742 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing | |
2743 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is | |
2744 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file. | |
2745 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better | |
2746 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap | |
2747 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your | |
2748 home directory is tried first. | |
2749 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2750 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2751 uses another default. | |
2752 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2753 security reasons. | |
2754 | |
2755 *'display'* *'dy'* | |
9737
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2756 'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in |
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2757 |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 2758 global |
2759 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of | |
2760 flags: | |
2761 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line | |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2762 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2763 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2764 rest of the line is not displayed. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2765 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2766 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline". |
7 | 2767 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx> |
2768 instead of using ^C and ~C. | |
2769 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
2770 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2771 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2772 |
7 | 2773 *'eadirection'* *'ead'* |
2774 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both") | |
2775 global | |
2776 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies: | |
2777 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected | |
2778 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected | |
2779 both width and height of windows is affected | |
2780 | |
2781 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'* | |
2782 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off) | |
2783 global | |
2784 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be | |
2785 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See | |
2786 also 'gdefault' option. | |
11442 | 2787 Switching this option on may break plugins! |
7 | 2788 |
8876
47f17f66da3d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8835
diff
changeset
|
2789 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2790 'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on) |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2791 global |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2792 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width. |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2793 |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2794 |
7 | 2795 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543* |
2796 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG) | |
2797 global | |
2798 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in | |
2799 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the | |
2800 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work | |
2801 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values. | |
2802 | |
2803 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the | |
39 | 2804 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid. |
7 | 2805 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim |
1152 | 2806 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|. |
7 | 2807 |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2808 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2809 corrupt the text. |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2810 |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2811 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' |
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2812 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of |
7 | 2813 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and |
2814 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made | |
10 | 2815 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal |
7 | 2816 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files |
2817 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty). | |
2818 | |
2819 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'. | |
10 | 2820 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with |
7 | 2821 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'. |
2822 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2823 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2824 can use: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2825 if has("multi_byte_encoding") |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2826 < |
7 | 2827 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will |
2828 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If | |
2829 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be | |
2830 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|. | |
2831 | |
2832 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand | |
2833 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary. | |
2834 | |
2835 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2836 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated | |
2837 to '-' signs. | |
2838 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name. | |
2839 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes | |
2840 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8". | |
2841 | |
2842 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected. | |
2843 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the | |
2844 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and | |
2845 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using | |
2846 utf-8. | |
2847 | |
2848 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8. | |
2849 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the | |
2850 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus | |
2851 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has | |
2852 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty. | |
448 | 2853 |
2854 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was | |
2855 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed. | |
7 | 2856 |
2857 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'* | |
2858 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on) | |
2859 local to buffer | |
2860 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option | |
6933 | 2861 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the |
2862 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when | |
2863 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL> | |
2864 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or | |
2865 reset this option. | |
2866 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when | |
2867 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used | |
2868 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so | |
2869 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can | |
2870 be kept. But you can change it if you want to. | |
7 | 2871 |
2872 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'* | |
2873 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on) | |
2874 global | |
2875 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after | |
33 | 2876 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the |
2877 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the | |
2878 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When | |
2879 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it | |
2880 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright'). | |
7 | 2881 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size |
2882 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The | |
2883 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected. | |
1354 | 2884 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting |
2885 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2886 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2887 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2888 the future). |
7 | 2889 |
2890 *'equalprg'* *'ep'* | |
2891 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "") | |
2892 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2893 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty | |
1621 | 2894 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2895 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2896 the "indent" program is used. |
10 | 2897 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
7 | 2898 about including spaces and backslashes. |
2899 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2900 security reasons. | |
2901 | |
2902 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'* | |
2903 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off) | |
2904 global | |
2905 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only | |
2906 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always | |
2907 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal | |
10 | 2908 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep, |
6949 | 2909 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the |
2910 bell. | |
7 | 2911 |
2912 *'errorfile'* *'ef'* | |
2913 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err", | |
2914 others: "errors.err") | |
2915 global | |
2916 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2917 feature} | |
2918 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|). | |
2919 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the | |
2920 following argument. See |-q|. | |
2921 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that. | |
2922 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2923 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
2924 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2925 security reasons. | |
2926 | |
2927 *'errorformat'* *'efm'* | |
2928 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long) | |
2929 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2930 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2931 feature} | |
2932 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file | |
2933 (see |errorformat|). | |
2934 | |
2935 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'* | |
2936 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
2937 global | |
2938 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert | |
2939 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be | |
2940 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of | |
2941 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of | |
2942 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to | |
2943 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that | |
2944 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys | |
2945 won't work by default. | |
2946 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2947 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
18590
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2948 NOTE: when this option is off then the |modifyOtherKeys| functionality |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2949 is disabled while in Insert mode to avoid ending Insert mode with any |
41484f342f80
patch 8.1.2289: after :diffsplit closing the window does not disable diff
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18574
diff
changeset
|
2950 key that has a modifier. |
7 | 2951 |
2952 *'eventignore'* *'ei'* | |
2953 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "") | |
2954 global | |
2955 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored. | |
844 | 2956 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand |
2957 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed. | |
7 | 2958 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: > |
2959 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave | |
2960 < | |
2961 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'* | |
2962 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off) | |
2963 local to buffer | |
2964 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a | |
10 | 2965 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and |
7 | 2966 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is |
2967 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2968 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2969 the 'paste' option is reset. |
7 | 2970 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2971 | |
2972 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'* | |
2973 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off) | |
2974 global | |
2975 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current | |
10027
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2976 directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2977 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2978 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2979 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2980 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION! |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2981 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2982 matching directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2983 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2984 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2985 'secure' option (see |initialization|). |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2986 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|. |
7 | 2987 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2988 security reasons. | |
2989 | |
2990 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213* | |
2991 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "") | |
2992 local to buffer | |
2993 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2994 |
7 | 2995 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2996 done when writing the file. For reading see below. |
7 | 2997 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be |
2998 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file). | |
11062 | 2999 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used, |
3000 only when writing a file. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3001 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3002 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3003 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8. |
7 | 3004 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3005 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3006 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3007 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3008 characters may be lost! |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3009 |
7 | 3010 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be |
3011 specified that can be handled by the converter, see | |
3012 |mbyte-conversion|. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3013 |
7 | 3014 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'. |
3015 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting | |
1152 | 3016 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when |
3017 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used. | |
692 | 3018 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used. |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3019 |
7 | 3020 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored. |
3021 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
3022 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are | |
3023 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for | |
3024 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example | |
3025 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2". | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3026 |
7 | 3027 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' |
3028 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3029 |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3030 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3031 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3032 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3033 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q". |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
3034 |
7 | 3035 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. |
3036 | |
3037 *'fe'* | |
3038 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the | |
10 | 3039 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The |
7 | 3040 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used. |
3041 | |
3042 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'* | |
39 | 3043 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom", |
3044 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when | |
3045 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value) | |
7 | 3046 global |
3047 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit | |
3048 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first | |
3049 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one | |
3050 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works, | |
10 | 3051 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to |
7 | 3052 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used. |
3053 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When | |
3054 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants) | |
3055 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse | |
3056 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not | |
596 | 3057 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use |
3058 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters | |
3059 that can't be converted. | |
7 | 3060 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings |
3061 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except | |
3062 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer | |
3063 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your | |
3064 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: > | |
3065 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 | | |
3066 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif | |
3067 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain | |
3068 non-blank characters. | |
596 | 3069 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is |
3070 not used. | |
692 | 3071 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value |
3072 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: > | |
3073 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2 | |
3074 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than | |
3075 an empty file. | |
7 | 3076 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM |
3077 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded | |
3078 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly. | |
3079 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last, | |
3080 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always | |
3081 accepted. | |
39 | 3082 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the |
3083 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful | |
3084 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a | |
3085 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian. | |
777 | 3086 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte |
3087 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8| | |
3088 command to find the illegal byte sequence. | |
7 | 3089 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG: |
3090 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used | |
3091 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8 | |
3092 file | |
3093 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used | |
3094 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified. | |
3095 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values. | |
3096 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file | |
3097 is read. | |
3098 | |
3099 *'fileformat'* *'ff'* | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3100 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3101 Unix, macOS default: "unix") |
7 | 3102 local to buffer |
3103 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for | |
3104 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file: | |
3105 dos <CR> <NL> | |
3106 unix <NL> | |
3107 mac <CR> | |
3108 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored. | |
3109 See |file-formats| and |file-read|. | |
3110 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'. | |
3111 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O | |
4264 | 3112 works like it was set to "unix". |
7 | 3113 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and |
3114 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off. | |
3115 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' | |
3116 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
3117 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. | |
3118 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos", | |
3119 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset. | |
3120 | |
3121 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'* | |
3122 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default: | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3123 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3124 Vim Unix, macOS: "unix,dos", |
7 | 3125 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos", |
3126 Vi others: "") | |
3127 global | |
3128 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when | |
3129 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing | |
3130 buffer: | |
3131 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used | |
3132 always. It is not set automatically. | |
3133 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer | |
10 | 3134 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The |
7 | 3135 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing |
3136 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to. | |
3137 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic | |
3138 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to | |
3139 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>: | |
3140 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos", | |
3141 'fileformat' is set to "dos". | |
3142 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat' | |
10 | 3143 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a |
7 | 3144 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos". |
6647 | 3145 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and |
3146 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac". | |
2587 | 3147 This means that "mac" is only chosen when: |
3148 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and | |
3149 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file. | |
3150 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before | |
3151 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in | |
2642 | 3152 the first few lines, "mac" is used. |
7 | 3153 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from |
3154 'fileformats' is used. | |
3155 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but | |
3156 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that | |
3157 file only, the option is not changed. | |
3158 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used. | |
3159 | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3160 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3161 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc. |
2662 | 3162 |
7 | 3163 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that |
3164 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be | |
3165 done: | |
3166 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos | |
3167 format will be used. | |
3168 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection | |
3169 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a | |
3170 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is | |
3171 used. | |
3172 Also see |file-formats|. | |
3173 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty | |
3174 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset, | |
3175 otherwise 'textauto' is set. | |
3176 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
3177 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3178 | |
4264 | 3179 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'* |
3180 'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file | |
3181 names is normally ignored) | |
4242 | 3182 global |
3183 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories. | |
3184 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion. | |
3185 | |
7 | 3186 *'filetype'* *'ft'* |
3187 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "") | |
3188 local to buffer | |
3189 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered. | |
3190 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be | |
3191 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file | |
3192 name. | |
3193 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type. | |
3194 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable | |
3195 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype| | |
3196 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline, | |
3197 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized. | |
782 | 3198 Example, for in an IDL file: |
3199 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~ | |
3200 |FileType| |filetypes| | |
3201 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
3202 names. Example: | |
3203 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
3204 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype. | |
3205 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than | |
3206 one dot may appear. | |
7 | 3207 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or |
3208 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 3209 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 3210 |
3211 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'* | |
3212 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-") | |
3213 global | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
3214 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
3215 feature} |
7 | 3216 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators. |
3217 It is a comma separated list of items: | |
3218 | |
3219 item default Used for ~ | |
3220 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3221 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows |
7 | 3222 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit| |
3223 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext' | |
3224 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option | |
3225 | |
10 | 3226 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3227 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '=' |
7 | 3228 otherwise. |
3229 | |
3230 Example: > | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3231 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:- |
7 | 3232 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also |
3233 be used when there is highlighting. | |
3234 | |
819 | 3235 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported. |
3236 | |
7 | 3237 The highlighting used for these items: |
3238 item highlight group ~ | |
3239 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine| | |
3240 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC| | |
3241 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit| | |
3242 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded| | |
3243 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete| | |
3244 | |
6933 | 3245 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'* |
3246 'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on) | |
3247 local to buffer | |
3248 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file | |
3249 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to | |
3250 preserve the situation from the original file. | |
3251 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't | |
3252 matter. | |
3253 See the 'endofline' option. | |
3254 | |
7 | 3255 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'* |
3256 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198* | |
3257 global | |
3258 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3259 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3260 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3261 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 3262 |
3263 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'* | |
3264 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "") | |
3265 global | |
3266 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3267 feature} | |
3268 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and | |
3269 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to | |
3270 automatically close when moving out of them. | |
3271 | |
3272 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'* | |
3273 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0) | |
3274 local to window | |
3275 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3276 feature} | |
3277 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side | |
3278 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum | |
3279 value is 12. | |
3280 See |folding|. | |
3281 | |
3282 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'* | |
3283 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on) | |
3284 local to window | |
3285 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3286 feature} | |
3287 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly | |
3288 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with | |
3289 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled | |
10 | 3290 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when |
7 | 3291 'foldenable' is off. |
3292 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold. | |
3293 See |folding|. | |
3294 | |
3295 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'* | |
3296 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0") | |
3297 local to window | |
3298 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3299 or |+eval| features} |
7 | 3300 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated |
634 | 3301 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|. |
782 | 3302 |
3682 | 3303 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3304 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3305 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3306 on or the 'modelineexpr' option is off. |
634 | 3307 |
3308 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3309 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|. | |
7 | 3310 |
3311 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'* | |
3312 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#") | |
3313 local to window | |
3314 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3315 feature} | |
3316 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with | |
3317 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding | |
10 | 3318 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character. |
7 | 3319 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|. |
3320 | |
3321 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'* | |
3322 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0) | |
3323 local to window | |
3324 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3325 feature} | |
3326 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed. | |
3327 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will | |
3328 close fewer folds. | |
3329 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|. | |
3330 See |fold-foldlevel|. | |
3331 | |
3332 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'* | |
3333 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1) | |
3334 global | |
3335 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3336 feature} | |
3337 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window. | |
3338 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero), | |
3339 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99). | |
3340 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline | |
10 | 3341 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also |
7 | 3342 ignores this option and closes all folds. |
3343 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to | |
3344 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files. | |
3345 When the value is negative, it is not used. | |
3346 | |
3347 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536* | |
3348 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}") | |
3349 local to window | |
3350 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3351 feature} | |
3352 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There | |
3353 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The | |
3354 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow). | |
3355 See |fold-marker|. | |
3356 | |
3357 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'* | |
3358 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual") | |
3359 local to window | |
3360 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3361 feature} | |
3362 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values: | |
3363 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually. | |
3364 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold. | |
3365 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line. | |
3366 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds. | |
3367 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds. | |
3368 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed. | |
3369 | |
3370 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'* | |
3371 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1) | |
3372 local to window | |
3373 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3374 feature} | |
2709 | 3375 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed |
3376 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of | |
3377 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines. | |
3378 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line. | |
2826 | 3379 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using |
7 | 3380 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller |
3381 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold. | |
3382 | |
3383 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'* | |
3384 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20) | |
3385 local to window | |
3386 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3387 feature} | |
3388 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax" | |
3389 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more | |
3390 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20. | |
3391 | |
3392 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'* | |
3393 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix, | |
3394 search,tag,undo") | |
3395 global | |
3396 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3397 feature} | |
3398 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the | |
3399 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated | |
3400 list of items. | |
2625 | 3401 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. |
3402 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect. | |
3403 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself) | |
3404 | |
7 | 3405 item commands ~ |
3406 all any | |
3407 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc. | |
3408 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc. | |
3409 insert any command in Insert mode | |
3410 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc. | |
3411 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc. | |
3412 percent "%" | |
3413 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc. | |
3414 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc. | |
3415 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command) | |
819 | 3416 Also for |[s| and |]s|. |
7 | 3417 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc. |
3418 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R | |
3419 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%") | |
3420 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the | |
3421 whole closed fold. | |
3422 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it | |
3423 very difficult to move onto a closed fold. | |
3424 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open | |
3425 when text is inserted. | |
3426 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or | |
3427 set the 'foldclose' option to "all". | |
3428 | |
3429 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'* | |
3430 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()") | |
3431 local to window | |
3432 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3433 feature} | |
3434 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed | |
3435 fold. See |fold-foldtext|. | |
3436 | |
3682 | 3437 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3438 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3439 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 3440 |
3441 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3442 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|. | |
3443 | |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3444 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'* |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3445 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "") |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3446 local to buffer |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3447 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3448 feature} |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3449 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3450 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3451 option is empty 'formatprg' is used. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3452 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3453 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3454 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3455 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3456 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3457 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3458 it yet! |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3459 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3460 Example: > |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3461 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format() |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3462 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3463 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3464 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3465 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3466 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3467 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3468 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3469 return "i" or "R" in this situation. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
3470 |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3471 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3472 the internal format mechanism. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3473 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3474 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3475 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3476 since changing the buffer text is not allowed. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3477 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
11160 | 3478 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3479 |
41 | 3480 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'* |
3481 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*") | |
3482 local to buffer | |
3483 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for | |
3484 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'. | |
3485 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for | |
140 | 3486 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match |
41 | 3487 while still checking more characters. There must be a character |
3488 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled | |
3489 like there is no match. | |
3490 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation | |
3491 character and white space. | |
3492 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3493 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3494 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt") |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3495 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3496 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3497 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3498 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3499 be inserted for readability. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3500 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3501 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3502 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3503 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3504 |
7 | 3505 *'formatprg'* *'fp'* |
3506 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "") | |
10579
688b97124d23
patch 8.0.0179: cannot have a local value for 'formatprg'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10498
diff
changeset
|
3507 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 3508 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines |
667 | 3509 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on |
7 | 3510 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is |
557 | 3511 such a program. |
667 | 3512 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead. |
3513 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal | |
3514 format function will be used |C-indenting|. | |
557 | 3515 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
3516 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3682 | 3517 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
3518 security reasons. | |
667 | 3519 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
3520 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'* |
36 | 3521 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on) |
3522 global | |
3523 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a | |
3524 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely | |
3525 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This | |
3526 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop | |
3527 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that | |
3528 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On | |
3529 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always | |
3530 off. | |
3531 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files. | |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3532 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()|, unless a flag is used to |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3533 overrule it. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3534 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3535 security reasons. |
36 | 3536 |
7 | 3537 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'* |
3538 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off) | |
3539 global | |
3540 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that | |
3541 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag | |
3542 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution | |
3543 of all or one match. See |complex-change|. | |
3544 | |
3545 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~ | |
3546 :s/// subst. all subst. one | |
3547 :s///g subst. one subst. all | |
3548 :s///gg subst. all subst. one | |
3549 | |
3550 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3551 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3552 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3553 has the opposite effect of that it normally does. |
7 | 3554 |
3555 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'* | |
6213 | 3556 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m") |
7 | 3557 global |
3558 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output. | |
3559 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the | |
3560 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|. | |
3561 | |
3562 *'grepprg'* *'gp'* | |
3563 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ", | |
3564 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null", | |
3565 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n", | |
3566 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ") | |
3567 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
233 | 3568 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%' |
7 | 3569 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command- |
3570 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments | |
3571 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See | |
3572 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3573 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep" | |
3574 also work well with a single file: > | |
3575 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH | |
161 | 3576 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command |
657 | 3577 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like |
3578 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|. | |
41 | 3579 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there |
7 | 3580 apply equally to 'grepprg'. |
3581 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found, | |
3582 otherwise it's "grep -n". | |
3583 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3584 security reasons. | |
3585 | |
3586 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549* | |
3587 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3588 ve:ver35-Cursor, | |
3589 o:hor50-Cursor, | |
3590 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3591 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3592 sm:block-Cursor | |
3593 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175", | |
18972 | 3594 for Win32 console: |
7 | 3595 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15, |
3596 r-cr:hor30,sm:block") | |
3597 global | |
3598 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and | |
18972 | 3599 for Win32 console} |
7 | 3600 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different |
19116 | 3601 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In a Win32 console, only the |
18972 | 3602 height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by specifying a |
3603 block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or horizontal cursor. | |
6727 | 3604 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are |
3605 used. | |
7 | 3606 |
10 | 3607 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a |
7 | 3608 mode-list and an argument-list: |
3609 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,.. | |
3610 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes: | |
3611 n Normal mode | |
3612 v Visual mode | |
3613 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
3614 if not specified) | |
3615 o Operator-pending mode | |
3616 i Insert mode | |
3617 r Replace mode | |
3618 c Command-line Normal (append) mode | |
3619 ci Command-line Insert mode | |
3620 cr Command-line Replace mode | |
3621 sm showmatch in Insert mode | |
3622 a all modes | |
3623 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments: | |
3624 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height | |
3625 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width | |
3626 block block cursor, fills the whole character | |
3627 [only one of the above three should be present] | |
3628 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking* | |
3629 blinkon{N} | |
3630 blinkoff{N} | |
3631 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before | |
3632 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that | |
3633 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the | |
3634 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one | |
3635 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The | |
3636 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250". | |
3637 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This | |
3638 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch | |
3639 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only | |
3640 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while | |
3641 executing a command. | |
3642 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see | |
3643 |xterm-blink|. | |
3644 {group-name} | |
3645 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font | |
3646 for the cursor | |
3647 {group-name}/{group-name} | |
3648 Two highlight group names, the first is used when | |
3649 no language mappings are used, the other when they | |
3650 are. |language-mapping| | |
3651 | |
3652 Examples of parts: | |
3653 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a | |
3654 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor" | |
3655 highlight group | |
3656 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150 | |
3657 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a | |
3658 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the | |
3659 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit | |
3660 faster. | |
3661 | |
3662 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for | |
3663 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used | |
3664 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off | |
3665 blinking: "a:blinkon0" | |
3666 | |
3667 Examples of cursor highlighting: > | |
3668 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE | |
3669 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg | |
3670 < | |
3671 *'guifont'* *'gfn'* | |
2908 | 3672 *E235* *E596* |
7 | 3673 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "") |
3674 global | |
3675 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3676 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3677 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. |
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3678 See |gui-font| for the details. |
7 | 3679 |
3680 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'* | |
3681 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598* | |
3682 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "") | |
3683 global | |
3684 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
3685 with the |+xfontset| feature} | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
3686 {not available in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 3687 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first |
3688 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See | |
3689 |xfontset|. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3690 |
7 | 3691 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534* |
3692 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "") | |
3693 global | |
3694 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3695 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used | |
3696 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3697 used. See |gui-fontwide|. |
4055 | 3698 |
7 | 3699 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'* |
3700 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50) | |
3701 global | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3702 {only for GTK and X11 GUI} |
7 | 3703 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting |
3704 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started, | |
3705 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will | |
10 | 3706 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel |
7 | 3707 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the |
3708 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the | |
3709 screen. | |
3710 | |
3711 *'guioptions'* *'go'* | |
14945 | 3712 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows, |
3713 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|), | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3714 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena), |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3715 ) |
7 | 3716 global |
3717 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
8 | 3718 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a |
7 | 3719 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the |
3720 GUI should be used. | |
3721 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
3722 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
3723 | |
13470
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3724 Valid characters are as follows: |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3725 *'go-!'* |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3726 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3727 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3728 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3729 terminal to list the command output. |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3730 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3731 upwards as needed. |
14999 | 3732 *'go-a'* |
7 | 3733 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started, |
3734 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of | |
3735 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the | |
3736 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other | |
3737 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode | |
3738 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an | |
3739 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text | |
3740 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register. | |
3741 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other | |
3742 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended. | |
3743 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the | |
3744 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to | |
3745 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register. | |
3746 The same applies to the modeless selection. | |
3674 | 3747 *'go-P'* |
3748 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "* | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
3749 register. |
1152 | 3750 *'go-A'* |
10 | 3751 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only |
7 | 3752 applies to the modeless selection. |
3753 | |
3754 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~ | |
3755 "" - - | |
3756 "a" yes yes | |
3757 "A" - yes | |
3758 "aA" yes yes | |
3759 | |
1152 | 3760 *'go-c'* |
7 | 3761 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple |
3762 choices. | |
18078
5ae41d0ea397
patch 8.1.2034: dark them of GTK 3 not supported
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18068
diff
changeset
|
3763 *'go-d'* |
5ae41d0ea397
patch 8.1.2034: dark them of GTK 3 not supported
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18068
diff
changeset
|
3764 'd' Use dark theme variant if available. Currently only works for |
5ae41d0ea397
patch 8.1.2034: dark them of GTK 3 not supported
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18068
diff
changeset
|
3765 GTK+ GUI. |
1152 | 3766 *'go-e'* |
697 | 3767 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'. |
688 | 3768 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels. |
3769 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used. | |
857 | 3770 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently |
1621 | 3771 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows. |
1152 | 3772 *'go-f'* |
7 | 3773 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell |
3774 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the | |
3775 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you | |
3776 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the | |
3777 foreground. |gui-fork| | |
3778 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have | |
819 | 3779 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read. |
1152 | 3780 *'go-i'* |
7 | 3781 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper |
3782 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of | |
3783 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3784 *'go-m'* |
7 | 3785 'm' Menu bar is present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3786 *'go-M'* |
10 | 3787 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note |
7 | 3788 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before |
819 | 3789 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc| |
7 | 3790 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
3791 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too). |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3792 *'go-g'* |
7 | 3793 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If |
3794 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all. | |
3795 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items. | |
1152 | 3796 *'go-t'* |
7 | 3797 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32, |
3798 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI. | |
1152 | 3799 *'go-T'* |
236 | 3800 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon |
856 | 3801 and Athena GUIs. |
1152 | 3802 *'go-r'* |
7 | 3803 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3804 *'go-R'* |
7 | 3805 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3806 split window. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3807 *'go-l'* |
7 | 3808 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3809 *'go-L'* |
7 | 3810 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3811 split window. | |
1152 | 3812 *'go-b'* |
7 | 3813 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on |
3814 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h' | |
3815 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3816 *'go-h'* |
7 | 3817 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor |
3818 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
3819 | |
3820 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if | |
3821 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information. | |
3822 | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3823 *'go-v'* |
7 | 3824 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included, |
3825 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a | |
3826 vertical layout is used anyway. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3827 *'go-p'* |
7 | 3828 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some |
3829 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at | |
3830 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done | |
819 | 3831 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or |
7 | 3832 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3833 *'go-F'* |
10 | 3834 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|. |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3835 *'go-k'* |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3836 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3837 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3838 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3839 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3840 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3841 removing GUI components. |
1152 | 3842 |
7 | 3843 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'* |
3844 'guipty' boolean (default on) | |
3845 global | |
3846 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3847 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for | |
3848 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|. | |
3849 | |
688 | 3850 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'* |
3851 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty) | |
3852 global | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
3853 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} |
688 | 3854 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab |
857 | 3855 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a |
3856 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info. | |
688 | 3857 |
692 | 3858 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
839 | 3859 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below. |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3860 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3861 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3862 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
692 | 3863 |
688 | 3864 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be |
3865 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is | |
3866 used. | |
3867 | |
839 | 3868 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'* |
3869 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty) | |
3870 global | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
3871 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} |
839 | 3872 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab |
3873 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip. | |
3874 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3875 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3876 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3877 < |
839 | 3878 |
7 | 3879 *'helpfile'* *'hf'* |
18972 | 3880 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MS-Windows) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt" |
7 | 3881 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt") |
3882 global | |
3883 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be | |
3884 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories | |
3885 in 'runtimepath' will be used. | |
3886 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example: | |
3887 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also | |
10 | 3888 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including |
7 | 3889 spaces and backslashes. |
3890 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3891 security reasons. | |
3892 | |
3893 *'helpheight'* *'hh'* | |
3894 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20) | |
3895 global | |
3896 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the | |
3897 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the | |
3898 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other | |
3899 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is | |
3900 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable. | |
3901 | |
3902 *'helplang'* *'hlg'* | |
3903 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty) | |
3904 global | |
3905 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang| | |
3906 feature} | |
3907 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language | |
3908 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always | |
3909 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over | |
3910 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that | |
3911 language and not in the English help. | |
3912 Example: > | |
3913 :set helplang=de,it | |
3914 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help | |
3915 files. | |
3916 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will | |
3917 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option. | |
3918 See |help-translated|. | |
3919 | |
3920 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'* | |
3921 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off) | |
3922 global | |
3923 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a | |
3924 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still | |
3925 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course. | |
3926 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer | |
3927 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is | |
3928 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!' | |
10 | 3929 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|. |
12 | 3930 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option. |
7 | 3931 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|. |
3932 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers. | |
3933 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!". | |
3934 | |
3935 *'highlight'* *'hl'* | |
3936 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string): | |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3937 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3938 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3939 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr, |
18471
b9cf60801963
patch 8.1.2229: cannot color number column above/below cursor differently
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18465
diff
changeset
|
3940 a:LineNrAbove,b:LineNrBelow, |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3941 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3942 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title, |
15194 | 3943 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg, |
3944 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn, | |
3945 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete, | |
3946 T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,-:Conceal, | |
15281 | 3947 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare, |
15194 | 3948 L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel, |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3949 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine, |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3950 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn, |
11914 | 3951 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine, |
12254 | 3952 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC") |
7 | 3953 global |
3954 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various | |
3955 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The | |
3956 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to | |
10 | 3957 use for that occasion. The occasions are: |
7 | 3958 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map" |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3959 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3960 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and |
7 | 3961 characters from 'showbreak' |
3962 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special | |
3963 things in listings | |
3964 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages | |
3965 h (obsolete, ignored) | |
3966 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting | |
3967 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch') | |
3968 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt| | |
3969 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --") | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3970 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3971 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set. |
18471
b9cf60801963
patch 8.1.2229: cannot color number column above/below cursor differently
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18465
diff
changeset
|
3972 |hl-LineNrAbove| a line number above the cursor for when the |
b9cf60801963
patch 8.1.2229: cannot color number column above/below cursor differently
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18465
diff
changeset
|
3973 'relativenumber' option is set. |
b9cf60801963
patch 8.1.2229: cannot color number column above/below cursor differently
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18465
diff
changeset
|
3974 |hl-LineNrBelow| b line number below the cursor for when the |
b9cf60801963
patch 8.1.2229: cannot color number column above/below cursor differently
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18465
diff
changeset
|
3975 'relativenumber' option is set. |
4073 | 3976 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is |
3977 set. | |
7 | 3978 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions |
3979 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line| | |
12785 | 3980 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows |
7 | 3981 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc. |
3982 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows | |
3983 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode | |
3984 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the | |
3985 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and | |
3986 |xterm-clipboard|. | |
3987 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages | |
3988 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu' | |
3989 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds | |
3990 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn' | |
386 | 3991 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode |
3992 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode | |
3993 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode | |
3994 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode | |
7 | 3995 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs| |
15194 | 3996 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters |
3997 (see 'conceallevel') | |
221 | 3998 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell| |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3999 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell| |
221 | 4000 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell| |
4001 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell| | |
15194 | 4002 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line |
4003 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line | |
4004 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar | |
4005 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb | |
7 | 4006 |
4007 The display modes are: | |
4008 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me") | |
4009 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR") | |
4010 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me") | |
4011 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se") | |
4012 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue") | |
205 | 4013 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce") |
12317
2a8890b80923
patch 8.0.1038: strike-through text not supported
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12293
diff
changeset
|
4014 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te") |
7 | 4015 n no highlighting |
4016 - no highlighting | |
4017 : use a highlight group | |
4018 The default is used for occasions that are not included. | |
4019 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors| | |
4020 for an example. | |
4021 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of | |
4022 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type | |
4023 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to | |
4024 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion. | |
4025 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups. | |
4026 | |
4027 *'history'* *'hi'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4028 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4029 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 4030 global |
4031 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns | |
5991 | 4032 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in |
7 | 4033 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|). |
5991 | 4034 The maximum value is 10000. |
7 | 4035 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
4036 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4037 | |
4038 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'* | |
4039 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off) | |
4040 global | |
4041 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
4042 feature} | |
4043 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set. | |
4044 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to | |
4045 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|. | |
4046 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4047 | |
4048 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'* | |
4049 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off) | |
4050 global | |
4051 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
4052 feature} | |
4053 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on. | |
4054 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard. | |
4055 See |rileft.txt|. | |
4056 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4057 | |
11160 | 4058 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'* |
4059 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off) | |
4060 global | |
4061 {not available when compiled without the | |
4062 |+extra_search| feature} | |
4063 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches. | |
4064 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the | |
4065 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by | |
4066 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets | |
4067 are not applied. | |
4068 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|. | |
4069 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it | |
4070 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as | |
4071 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back. | |
4072 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches. | |
4073 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to | |
4074 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the | |
4075 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first | |
4076 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not | |
4077 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line. | |
4078 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup | |
4079 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|. | |
4080 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4081 | |
7 | 4082 *'icon'* *'noicon'* |
4083 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
4084 global | |
4085 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4086 feature} | |
4087 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of | |
4088 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file | |
4089 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used. | |
4090 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option. | |
4091 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently | |
4092 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are | |
4093 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the | |
4094 builtin termcap). | |
4095 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
233 | 4096 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on |
7 | 4097 X11. |
6259 | 4098 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|. |
7 | 4099 |
4100 *'iconstring'* | |
4101 'iconstring' string (default "") | |
4102 global | |
4103 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4104 feature} | |
4105 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of | |
4106 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on. | |
4107 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text | |
4108 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option). | |
4109 Does not work for MS Windows. | |
4110 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
4111 restored if possible |X11|. | |
4112 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be | |
10 | 4113 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See |
7 | 4114 'titlestring' for example settings. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4115 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
7 | 4116 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} |
4117 | |
4118 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'* | |
4119 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off) | |
4120 global | |
4121 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags | |
4122 file. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
4123 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'. |
7 | 4124 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see |
4125 |/ignorecase|. | |
4126 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4127 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4128 'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4129 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4130 This option specifies a function that will be called to |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4131 activate or deactivate the Input Method. |
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4132 It is not used in the GUI. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4133 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4134 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4135 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4136 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4137 function ImActivateFunc(active) |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4138 if a:active |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4139 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4140 else |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4141 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4142 endif |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4143 " return value is not used |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4144 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4145 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4146 < |
7 | 4147 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'* |
4148 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "") | |
4149 global | |
4150 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and | |
2209
d0ddf7ba1630
Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2207
diff
changeset
|
4151 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599* |
7 | 4152 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for |
4153 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control | |
4154 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'. | |
4155 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option | |
4156 tells Vim what the key is. | |
4157 Format: | |
4158 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING | |
4159 | |
4160 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored): | |
4161 S Shift key | |
4162 L Lock key | |
4163 C Control key | |
4164 1 Mod1 key | |
4165 2 Mod2 key | |
4166 3 Mod3 key | |
4167 4 Mod4 key | |
4168 5 Mod5 key | |
4169 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are | |
4170 both shift+ctrl+space. | |
4171 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING. | |
4172 | |
4173 Example: > | |
4174 :set imactivatekey=S-space | |
4175 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 + | |
4176 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean). | |
4177 | |
4178 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'* | |
4179 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off) | |
4180 global | |
4181 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command | |
4182 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that). | |
4183 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering | |
4184 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented | |
4185 characters with dead keys. | |
4186 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4187 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'* |
7 | 4188 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI)) |
4189 global | |
4190 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable | |
4191 the IM when it doesn't work properly. | |
4192 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This | |
4193 may change in later releases. | |
4194 | |
4195 *'iminsert'* *'imi'* | |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4196 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0) |
7 | 4197 local to buffer |
4198 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in | |
4199 Insert mode. Valid values: | |
4200 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4201 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4202 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4203 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc> | |
4204 this can be used: > | |
4205 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR> | |
4206 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert | |
4207 mode. | |
4208 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode | |
4209 |i_CTRL-^|. | |
4210 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name. | |
4211 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f". | |
4212 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4213 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4214 | |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4215 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM |
14519 | 4216 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|, |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4217 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|. |
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4218 |
7 | 4219 *'imsearch'* *'ims'* |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4220 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1) |
7 | 4221 local to buffer |
4222 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when | |
4223 entering a search pattern. Valid values: | |
4224 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like | |
4225 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern | |
4226 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4227 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4228 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4229 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode | |
4230 |c_CTRL-^|. | |
4231 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap' | |
4232 option to a valid keymap name. | |
4233 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4234 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4235 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4236 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4237 'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4238 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4239 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4240 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active. |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4241 It is not used in the GUI. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4242 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4243 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4244 function ImStatusFunc() |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4245 let is_active = ...do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4246 return is_active ? 1 : 0 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4247 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4248 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4249 < |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4250 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4251 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4252 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4253 |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4254 *'imstyle'* *'imst'* |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4255 'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1) |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4256 global |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4257 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4258 |+GUI_GTK|} |
12499 | 4259 This option specifies the input style of Input Method: |
4260 0 use on-the-spot style | |
4261 1 over-the-spot style | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4262 See: |xim-input-style| |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4263 |
12559 | 4264 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of |
4265 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings, | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4266 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4267 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4268 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4269 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4270 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4271 |
7 | 4272 *'include'* *'inc'* |
4273 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include") | |
4274 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4275 {not available when compiled without the | |
4276 |+find_in_path| feature} | |
10 | 4277 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search |
7 | 4278 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default |
4279 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i", | |
532 | 4280 "]I", "[d", etc. |
4281 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that | |
534 | 4282 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern |
4283 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it | |
4284 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters | |
4285 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use | |
4286 'includeexpr' to process the matched text. | |
532 | 4287 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
7 | 4288 |
4289 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'* | |
4290 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "") | |
4291 local to buffer | |
4292 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4293 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features} |
7 | 4294 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include' |
10 | 4295 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: > |
7 | 4296 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g') |
4297 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected. | |
634 | 4298 |
7 | 4299 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be |
10 | 4300 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement. |
7 | 4301 Also used for |<cfile>|. |
4302 | |
3682 | 4303 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4304 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4305 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 4306 |
4307 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4308 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|. | |
4309 | |
7 | 4310 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4311 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4312 +reltime feature is supported) |
7 | 4313 global |
4314 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4315 |+extra_search| features} |
17 | 4316 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed |
4317 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern | |
4318 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated | |
4319 often, this is only useful on fast terminals. | |
14637 | 4320 Also applies to the pattern in commands: > |
4321 :global | |
4322 :lvimgrep | |
4323 :lvimgrepadd | |
4324 :smagic | |
4325 :snomagic | |
4326 :sort | |
4327 :substitute | |
4328 :vglobal | |
4329 :vimgrep | |
4330 :vimgrepadd | |
4331 < Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its | |
17 | 4332 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You |
4333 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the | |
4334 cursor to the match. | |
10261
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4335 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and |
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4336 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T| |
1521 | 4337 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about |
4338 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the | |
4339 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you | |
4340 are typing the pattern. | |
17 | 4341 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'. |
12968 | 4342 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while |
4343 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'. | |
14519 | 4344 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all |
4345 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with | |
4346 autocmd. Example: > | |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4347 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4348 autocmd! |
12744
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4349 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch |
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4350 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4351 augroup END |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4352 < |
772 | 4353 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match |
2302
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4354 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4355 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4356 converted to lowercase. |
772 | 4357 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current |
4358 match, excluding the characters that were already typed. | |
7 | 4359 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
4360 | |
4361 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'* | |
4362 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "") | |
4363 local to buffer | |
4364 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4365 or |+eval| features} | |
4366 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line. | |
4367 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and | |
4368 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option. | |
4369 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and | |
2833 | 4370 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is |
4371 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm. | |
7 | 4372 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting. |
4373 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for | |
534 | 4374 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line |
7 | 4375 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around). |
4376 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It | |
4377 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is | |
4378 used for the indent). | |
4379 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()| | |
4380 and |lispindent()|. | |
4381 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must | |
4382 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the | |
4383 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved. | |
4384 Normally this option would be set to call a function: > | |
4385 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent() | |
4386 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains | |
4387 "msg". | |
634 | 4388 See |indent-expression|. |
11160 | 4389 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 4390 |
3682 | 4391 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4392 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4393 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 4394 |
4395 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4396 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|. | |
4397 | |
4398 | |
7 | 4399 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'* |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
4400 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 4401 local to buffer |
4402 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4403 feature} | |
4404 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
4405 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty. | |
4406 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|. | |
4407 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|. | |
4408 | |
4409 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'* | |
4410 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off) | |
4411 local to buffer | |
4412 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and | |
1621 | 4413 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending |
4414 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter | |
4415 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made | |
4416 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match | |
4417 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter, | |
4418 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase. | |
4419 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is. | |
7 | 4420 |
4421 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'* | |
4422 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off) | |
4423 global | |
4424 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful | |
4425 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|. | |
4426 These Insert mode commands will be useful: | |
4427 - Use the cursor keys to move around. | |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4428 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When |
7 | 4429 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off. |
4430 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished. | |
4431 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use | |
477 | 4432 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor |
4433 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L| | |
7 | 4434 |
4435 These items change when 'insertmode' is set: | |
4436 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode. | |
4437 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps. | |
4438 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode. | |
4439 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted. | |
4440 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z* | |
4441 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like | |
4442 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same | |
4443 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set. | |
4444 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used. | |
4445 | |
4446 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4447 | |
4448 *'isfname'* *'isf'* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
4449 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for Win32: |
7 | 4450 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,=" |
4451 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:" | |
4452 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~" | |
4453 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=" | |
4454 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=") | |
4455 global | |
4456 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and | |
4457 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in | |
10 | 4458 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|. |
7 | 4459 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the |
4460 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. | |
4461 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well. | |
1621 | 4462 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a |
4463 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim | |
4464 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion. | |
4465 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'. | |
7 | 4466 |
4467 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to | |
4468 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit | |
4469 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special | |
4470 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file | |
4471 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The | |
4472 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for | |
4473 cmd.exe. | |
4474 | |
4475 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas. | |
10 | 4476 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two |
4477 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a | |
7 | 4478 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does |
4479 not work for digits). Example: | |
4480 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range | |
4481 128 to 140 and '#' to 43) | |
4482 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range | |
4483 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left | |
4484 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is | |
4485 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the | |
4486 option or the end of a range. Example: | |
4487 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^') | |
4488 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE | |
4489 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z, | |
4490 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples: | |
4491 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower | |
1621 | 4492 case ASCII letters. |
7 | 4493 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character. |
4494 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is | |
4495 expected. Example: | |
4496 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore. | |
4497 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example: | |
4498 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding | |
4499 comma, plus <Tab>. | |
4500 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4501 | |
4502 *'isident'* *'isi'* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
4503 'isident' 'isi' string (default for Win32: |
7 | 4504 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" |
4505 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255") | |
4506 global | |
4507 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers. | |
4508 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a | |
4509 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a | |
233 | 4510 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this |
14864 | 4511 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used. |
7 | 4512 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding |
10 | 4513 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to |
7 | 4514 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead. |
4515 | |
4516 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
4517 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for Win32: |
7 | 4518 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" |
4519 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255" | |
4520 Vi default: "@,48-57,_") | |
4521 local to buffer | |
4522 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands: | |
10 | 4523 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See |
14864 | 4524 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@' |
4525 characters above 255 check the "word" character class. | |
4526 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>". | |
7 | 4527 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except |
4528 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that | |
4529 command). | |
4530 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included. | |
7687
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4531 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax |
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4532 uses |:syn-iskeyword|. |
7 | 4533 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
4534 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4535 | |
4536 *'isprint'* *'isp'* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
4537 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for Win32 and Macintosh: |
7 | 4538 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255") |
4539 global | |
4540 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the | |
4541 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from | |
4542 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly, | |
4543 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See | |
4544 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. | |
4545 | |
4546 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters: | |
4547 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_" | |
4548 32 - 126 always single characters | |
4549 127 "^?" | |
4550 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_" | |
4551 160 - 254 "| " - "|~" | |
4552 255 "~?" | |
4553 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are | |
4554 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte. | |
4555 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are | |
4556 displayed as <xx>. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4557 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4558 |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4559 |
4560 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the | |
4561 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character | |
4562 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a | |
4563 replacement character will be shown. | |
4564 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>. | |
4565 There is no option to specify these characters. | |
4566 | |
4567 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'* | |
4568 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on) | |
4569 global | |
4570 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command. | |
4571 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'. | |
4572 Otherwise only one space is inserted. | |
4573 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
4574 | |
4575 *'key'* | |
4576 'key' string (default "") | |
4577 local to buffer | |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4578 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv| |
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4579 feature} |
7 | 4580 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
4581 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'. |
7 | 4582 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed |
4583 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: > | |
4584 :set key= | |
4585 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or | |
4586 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't | |
4587 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it, | |
4588 be careful not to make a typing error! | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4589 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4590 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars). |
7 | 4591 |
4592 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544* | |
4593 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "") | |
4594 local to buffer | |
4595 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap| | |
4596 feature} | |
4597 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|. | |
4598 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of | |
4599 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective. | |
4600 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1 | |
36 | 4601 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4602 |
4603 *'keymodel'* *'km'* | |
4604 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "") | |
4605 global | |
4606 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys | |
4607 can do. These values can be used: | |
4608 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either | |
4609 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being | |
4610 present in 'selectmode'). | |
4611 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection. | |
4612 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>, | |
4613 <PageUp> and <PageDown>. | |
4614 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
4615 | |
4616 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'* | |
4617 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help", | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4618 VMS: "help") |
7 | 4619 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
4620 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are | |
4621 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal | |
4622 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty | |
4623 value did this, which is now deprecated.) | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4624 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4625 Ex command prefixed with [count]. |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4626 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4627 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4628 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count. |
7 | 4629 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
4630 Example: > | |
4631 :set keywordprg=man\ -s | |
4632 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4633 security reasons. | |
4634 | |
4635 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358* | |
4636 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "") | |
4637 global | |
4638 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4639 feature} | |
4640 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language | |
10 | 4641 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4642 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes |
7 | 4643 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning |
4644 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to | |
4645 be able to execute Normal mode commands. | |
4646 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are | |
4647 mapped in Insert mode. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4648 Also consider resetting 'langremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to |
6369 | 4649 characters resulting from a mapping. |
5908 | 4650 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
4651 security reasons. | |
7 | 4652 |
699 | 4653 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* > |
4654 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz | |
7 | 4655 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): > |
4656 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ | |
4657 < | |
4658 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each | |
4659 part can be in one of two forms: | |
4660 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately | |
4661 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC". | |
4662 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to" | |
4663 characters. Example: "abc;ABC" | |
4664 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE" | |
4665 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are | |
4666 ";", ',' and backslash itself. | |
4667 | |
4668 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch | |
4669 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will | |
4670 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the | |
4671 langmap mappings) in the following cases: | |
4672 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings) | |
4673 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R | |
4674 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings | |
4675 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by | |
4676 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time | |
4677 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings. | |
4678 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time! | |
4679 | |
4680 *'langmenu'* *'lm'* | |
4681 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "") | |
4682 global | |
4683 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and | |
4684 |+multi_lang| features} | |
4685 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded | |
4686 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': > | |
4687 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim" | |
4688 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no | |
4689 matter what $LANG is set to: > | |
4690 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1 | |
4691 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used. | |
36 | 4692 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4693 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use |
4694 the English menus: > | |
4695 :set langmenu=none | |
4696 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype | |
4697 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting | |
4698 this option has no effect. But you could do this: > | |
4699 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim | |
4700 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1 | |
4701 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim | |
4702 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself! | |
4703 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4704 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4705 'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
6339 | 4706 global |
4707 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4708 feature} | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4709 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4710 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4711 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4712 |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4713 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'* |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4714 'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4715 global |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4716 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4717 feature} |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4718 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from |
6339 | 4719 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4720 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4721 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if |
6339 | 4722 that works for you to avoid mappings to break. |
4723 | |
7 | 4724 *'laststatus'* *'ls'* |
4725 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1) | |
4726 global | |
4727 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a | |
4728 status line: | |
4729 0: never | |
4730 1: only if there are at least two windows | |
4731 2: always | |
4732 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several | |
4733 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line| | |
4734 | |
4735 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'* | |
4736 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off) | |
4737 global | |
4738 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while | |
4739 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been | |
10 | 4740 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an |
7 | 4741 update use |:redraw|. |
4742 | |
4743 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'* | |
4744 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off) | |
4745 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4746 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 4747 feature} |
6009 | 4748 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather |
7 | 4749 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike |
4750 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file, | |
6009 | 4751 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. |
4752 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value | |
4753 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option | |
6026 | 4754 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off. |
7 | 4755 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed |
4756 with the right amount of white space. | |
4757 | |
4758 *'lines'* *E593* | |
4759 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height) | |
4760 global | |
4761 Number of lines of the Vim window. | |
4762 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the | |
161 | 4763 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|. |
7 | 4764 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
4765 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
4766 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
4767 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can | |
4768 use this command to get the tallest window possible: > | |
4769 :set lines=999 | |
571 | 4770 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000. |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4771 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option. |
7 | 4772 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical |
4773 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up. | |
4774 | |
4775 *'linespace'* *'lsp'* | |
4776 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI) | |
4777 global | |
4778 {only in the GUI} | |
4779 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font | |
4780 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other. | |
4781 When non-zero there is room for underlining. | |
180 | 4782 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have |
4783 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set | |
4784 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems | |
4785 though! | |
7 | 4786 |
4787 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'* | |
4788 'lisp' boolean (default off) | |
4789 local to buffer | |
4790 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| | |
4791 feature} | |
4792 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for | |
4793 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with | |
4794 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p' | |
4795 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or | |
4796 better. Also see 'lispwords'. | |
4797 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the | |
4798 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than | |
4799 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty. | |
4800 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
4801 | |
4802 *'lispwords'* *'lw'* | |
4803 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long) | |
5712 | 4804 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 4805 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| |
4806 feature} | |
4807 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting. | |
4808 |'lisp'| | |
4809 | |
4810 *'list'* *'nolist'* | |
4811 'list' boolean (default off) | |
4812 local to window | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4813 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4814 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4815 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4816 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4817 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4818 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4819 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: > |
5161
f7add3891e95
Updated runtime files. Fix NL translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5146
diff
changeset
|
4820 :set list lcs=tab:\ \ |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4821 < |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4822 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4823 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for |
7 | 4824 changing the way tabs are displayed. |
4825 | |
4826 *'listchars'* *'lcs'* | |
4827 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$") | |
4828 global | |
2458 | 4829 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a |
4830 comma separated list of string settings. | |
6777 | 4831 *lcs-eol* |
7 | 4832 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When |
4833 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the | |
4834 line. | |
6777 | 4835 *lcs-tab* |
15502
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4836 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4837 The third character is optional. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4838 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4839 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4840 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4841 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4842 >- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4843 >-- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4844 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4845 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4846 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4847 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4848 "tab:<->" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4849 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4850 <> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4851 <-> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4852 <--> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4853 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4854 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4855 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I. |
6777 | 4856 *lcs-space* |
4857 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces | |
4858 are left blank. | |
4859 *lcs-trail* | |
10 | 4860 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted, |
6777 | 4861 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" |
4862 setting for trailing spaces. | |
4863 *lcs-extends* | |
7 | 4864 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is |
4865 off and the line continues beyond the right of the | |
4866 screen. | |
6777 | 4867 *lcs-precedes* |
18131
851a014dfd8b
patch 8.1.2060: "precedes" in 'listchars' not used properly
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18130
diff
changeset
|
4868 precedes:c Character to show in the first visible column of the |
851a014dfd8b
patch 8.1.2060: "precedes" in 'listchars' not used properly
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18130
diff
changeset
|
4869 physical line, when there is text preceding the |
851a014dfd8b
patch 8.1.2060: "precedes" in 'listchars' not used properly
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18130
diff
changeset
|
4870 character visible in the first column. |
6777 | 4871 *lcs-conceal* |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
4872 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
4873 'conceallevel' is set to 1. |
6777 | 4874 *lcs-nbsp* |
6801 | 4875 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character |
4876 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when | |
4877 omitted. | |
7 | 4878 |
10 | 4879 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can |
7 | 4880 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable |
819 | 4881 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width. |
7 | 4882 |
4883 Examples: > | |
4884 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:- | |
12 | 4885 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:% |
7 | 4886 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:< |
4887 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and | |
6777 | 4888 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail". |
1152 | 4889 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4890 |
4891 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'* | |
4892 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on) | |
4893 global | |
4894 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|. | |
4895 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading | |
4896 of plugins. | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4897 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4898 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|. |
7 | 4899 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4900 *'luadll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
4901 'luadll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4902 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4903 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4904 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4905 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4906 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
4907 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4908 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4909 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4910 |
842 | 4911 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'* |
4912 'macatsui' boolean (default on) | |
4913 global | |
4914 {only available in Mac GUI version} | |
4915 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set | |
4916 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When | |
4917 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when | |
4918 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may | |
4919 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method | |
4920 to unset it: > | |
4921 if exists('&macatsui') | |
4922 set nomacatsui | |
4923 endif | |
1152 | 4924 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is |
4925 'termencoding'. | |
4926 | |
7 | 4927 *'magic'* *'nomagic'* |
4928 'magic' boolean (default on) | |
4929 global | |
4930 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns. | |
4931 See |pattern|. | |
10140
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4932 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4933 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off. |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4934 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4935 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M" |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4936 when you want to |/\M|. |
7 | 4937 |
4938 *'makeef'* *'mef'* | |
4939 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "") | |
4940 global | |
4941 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
4942 feature} | |
4943 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|) | |
4944 and the |:grep| command. | |
4945 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used. | |
4946 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name | |
4947 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an | |
4948 existing file. | |
4949 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that. | |
4950 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
4951 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4952 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4953 security reasons. | |
4954 | |
11063
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4955 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'* |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4956 'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "") |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4957 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4958 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4959 encoding is not converted. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4960 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4961 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4962 and `:laddfile`. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4963 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4964 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding' |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4965 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4966 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4967 locale encoding. Example: > |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4968 :set encoding=utf-8 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4969 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4970 < |
7 | 4971 *'makeprg'* *'mp'* |
4972 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS") | |
4973 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
1152 | 4974 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4975 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|), |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4976 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S| |
5690 | 4977 to escape file names in case they contain special characters. |
1152 | 4978 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
4979 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4980 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for | |
4981 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called | |
4982 "myfilter" do it like this: > | |
7 | 4983 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter |
4984 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify | |
4985 where the arguments will be included, for example: > | |
4986 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*} | |
4987 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4988 security reasons. | |
4989 | |
4990 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'* | |
4991 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]") | |
4992 local to buffer | |
4993 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the | |
4073 | 4994 other. |
4995 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot | |
4996 jump between two double quotes. | |
4997 The characters must be separated by a colon. | |
1152 | 4998 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and |
4999 '>' (HTML): > | |
7 | 5000 :set mps+=<:> |
5001 | |
5002 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an | |
5003 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: > | |
5004 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:; | |
5005 | |
5006 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in | |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
5007 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help| |
7 | 5008 |
5009 *'matchtime'* *'mat'* | |
5010 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5) | |
5011 global | |
5012 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is | |
5013 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that | |
5014 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi. | |
5015 | |
714 | 5016 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'* |
5017 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2) | |
5018 global | |
5019 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying. | |
5020 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8". | |
5021 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4. | |
5022 Maximum value is 6. | |
5023 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more | |
5024 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|. | |
5025 See |mbyte-combining|. | |
5026 | |
7 | 5027 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'* |
5028 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100) | |
5029 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5030 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
1152 | 5031 feature} |
7 | 5032 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally |
5033 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with | |
5034 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use | |
5035 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted. | |
10498
883396809b45
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc2eada5424bff06f7eb77c032ecc067da52b846
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10449
diff
changeset
|
5036 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex |
14006 | 5037 command recursion, see |E169|. |
7 | 5038 See also |:function|. |
5039 | |
5040 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223* | |
5041 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000) | |
5042 global | |
5043 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a | |
5044 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like | |
5045 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg", | |
5046 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also | |
5047 |key-mapping|. | |
5048 | |
5049 *'maxmem'* *'mm'* | |
5050 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system | |
5051 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
5052 available) | |
5053 global | |
5054 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this | |
5055 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5056 other memory to be freed. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5057 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5058 limit. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5059 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5060 Also see 'maxmemtot'. |
7 | 5061 |
189 | 5062 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'* |
5063 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000) | |
5064 global | |
5065 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5066 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. |
189 | 5067 *E363* |
1152 | 5068 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly |
5069 behaves like CTRL-C was typed. | |
189 | 5070 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very |
5071 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern | |
5072 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5073 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5074 text structure. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5075 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5076 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead. |
189 | 5077 |
7 | 5078 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'* |
5079 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system | |
5080 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
5081 available) | |
5082 global | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5083 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5084 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5085 without a limit. |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5086 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5087 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5088 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5089 need the memory to store undo info. |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5090 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5091 used. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5092 Also see 'maxmem'. |
7 | 5093 |
5094 *'menuitems'* *'mis'* | |
5095 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25) | |
5096 global | |
5097 {not available when compiled without the |+menu| | |
5098 feature} | |
5099 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are | |
5100 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this | |
5101 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first. | |
5102 | |
484 | 5103 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'* |
5104 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500") | |
5105 global | |
5106 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
5107 feature} | |
5108 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the | |
5109 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but | |
5110 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used | |
5111 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why | |
5112 this tuning is complicated. | |
5113 | |
5114 There are three numbers, separated by commas: | |
5115 {start},{inc},{added} | |
5116 | |
5117 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start} | |
5118 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any | |
5119 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of | |
5120 memory that is available to Vim. | |
5121 | |
5122 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the | |
5123 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another | |
5124 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after | |
5125 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory | |
5126 will be allocated. | |
5127 | |
5128 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before | |
5129 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra | |
5130 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller | |
5131 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's | |
5132 slower. | |
5133 | |
5134 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and | |
5135 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If | |
5136 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: > | |
5137 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800 | |
5138 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some | |
5139 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to. | |
5140 | |
16798
63ac51f16ea1
patch 8.1.1401: misspelled mkspellmem as makespellmem
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16778
diff
changeset
|
5141 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|. |
63ac51f16ea1
patch 8.1.1401: misspelled mkspellmem as makespellmem
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16778
diff
changeset
|
5142 |
7 | 5143 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'* |
1111 | 5144 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root), |
5145 Vi default: off) | |
7 | 5146 local to buffer |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5147 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5148 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5149 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5150 |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5151 *'modelineexpr'* *'mle'* *'nomodelineexpr'* *'nomle'* |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5152 'modelineexpr' 'mle' boolean (default: off) |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5153 global |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5154 When on allow some options that are an expression to be set in the |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5155 modeline. Check the option for whether it is affected by |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5156 'modelineexpr'. Also see |modeline|. |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
5157 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
5158 security reasons. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5159 |
7 | 5160 *'modelines'* *'mls'* |
5161 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5) | |
5162 global | |
5163 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is | |
5164 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero | |
5165 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. | |
5166 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5167 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5168 | |
5169 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'* | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5170 *E21* |
7 | 5171 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on) |
5172 local to buffer | |
5173 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and | |
5174 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed. | |
10617 | 5175 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument. |
7 | 5176 |
5177 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'* | |
5178 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off) | |
5179 local to buffer | |
5180 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set | |
5181 when: | |
5182 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the | |
5183 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the | |
5184 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the | |
5185 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from | |
5186 when it was written. | |
5187 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original | |
5188 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or | |
5189 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original | |
5190 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be | |
5191 reset. | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
5192 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'. |
3082 | 5193 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the |
5194 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost, | |
5195 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for | |
5196 an explanation. | |
7 | 5197 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but |
5198 will be ignored. | |
13437 | 5199 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set |
5200 when using "rA" on an "A". | |
7 | 5201 |
5202 *'more'* *'nomore'* | |
5203 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
5204 global | |
5205 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get | |
5206 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the | |
5207 listing continues until finished. | |
5208 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5209 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5210 | |
5211 *'mouse'* *E538* | |
18972 | 5212 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI and Win32, |
18465
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5213 set to "a" or "nvi" in |defaults.vim|) |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5214 global |
18972 | 5215 Enable the use of the mouse. Works for most terminals (xterm, Win32 |
5216 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with sysmouse and Linux console | |
5217 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|. The | |
5218 mouse can be enabled for different modes: | |
12826 | 5219 n Normal mode and Terminal modes |
7 | 5220 v Visual mode |
5221 i Insert mode | |
5222 c Command-line mode | |
5223 h all previous modes when editing a help file | |
5224 a all previous modes | |
5225 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt | |
14864 | 5226 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: > |
7 | 5227 :set mouse=a |
18465
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5228 < If your terminal can't overrule the mouse events going to the |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5229 application, use: > |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5230 :set mouse=nvi |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5231 < The you can press ":", select text for the system, and press Esc to go |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5232 back to Vim using the mouse events. |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5233 In |defaults.vim| "nvi" is used if the 'term' option is not matching |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5234 "xterm". |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5235 |
d7619a9874cd
patch 8.1.2226: cannot use system copy/paste in non-xterm terminals
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18463
diff
changeset
|
5236 When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for |
7 | 5237 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor. |
5238 | |
5239 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|. | |
5240 | |
5241 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the | |
10 | 5242 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of |
7 | 5243 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed. |
5244 Also see the 'clipboard' option. | |
5245 | |
5246 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'* | |
5247 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off) | |
5248 global | |
5249 {only works in the GUI} | |
5250 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated. | |
5251 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the | |
5252 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the | |
5253 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as | |
5254 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally. | |
18594 | 5255 MS-Windows: Also see 'scrollfocus' for what window is scrolled when |
19180 | 5256 using the mouse scroll wheel. |
7 | 5257 |
5258 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'* | |
5259 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on) | |
5260 global | |
5261 {only works in the GUI} | |
5262 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed. | |
5263 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved. | |
5264 | |
5265 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'* | |
18972 | 5266 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for Win32) |
7 | 5267 global |
5268 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what | |
5269 the right mouse button is used for: | |
5270 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works | |
5271 like in an xterm. | |
5272 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left | |
5273 mouse button extends a selection. This works like | |
233 | 5274 with Microsoft Windows. |
7 | 5275 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the |
5276 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the | |
5277 selected operation will act upon the clicked object. | |
5278 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will | |
233 | 5279 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of |
7 | 5280 course, that right clicking outside a selection will |
5281 end Visual mode. | |
5282 Overview of what button does what for each model: | |
5283 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~ | |
5284 left click place cursor place cursor | |
5285 left drag start selection start selection | |
5286 shift-left search word extend selection | |
5287 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor) | |
5288 right drag extend selection - | |
5289 middle click paste paste | |
5290 | |
5291 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu. | |
5292 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|. | |
5293 | |
5294 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings. | |
5295 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless | |
5296 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly). | |
5297 | |
5298 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5299 | |
5300 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547* | |
15932 | 5301 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing, |
5302 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no, | |
5303 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow") | |
7 | 5304 global |
5305 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape| | |
5306 feature} | |
5307 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in | |
5308 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much | |
5309 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list | |
5310 and an argument-list: | |
5311 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,.. | |
5312 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations: | |
5313 In a normal window: ~ | |
5314 n Normal mode | |
5315 v Visual mode | |
5316 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
5317 if not specified) | |
5318 o Operator-pending mode | |
5319 i Insert mode | |
5320 r Replace mode | |
5321 | |
5322 Others: ~ | |
5323 c appending to the command-line | |
5324 ci inserting in the command-line | |
5325 cr replacing in the command-line | |
5326 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts | |
5327 ml idem, but cursor in the last line | |
5328 e any mode, pointer below last window | |
5329 s any mode, pointer on a status line | |
5330 sd any mode, while dragging a status line | |
5331 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line | |
5332 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line | |
5333 a everywhere | |
5334 | |
5335 The shape is one of the following: | |
5336 avail name looks like ~ | |
5337 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer | |
5338 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!) | |
5339 w x beam I-beam | |
5340 w x updown up-down sizing arrows | |
5341 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows | |
5342 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer | |
5343 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer | |
5344 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing | |
5345 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing | |
5346 x crosshair like a big thin + | |
5347 x hand1 black hand | |
5348 x hand2 white hand | |
5349 x pencil what you write with | |
5350 x question big ? | |
5351 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up | |
5352 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up | |
5353 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h) | |
5354 | |
5355 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32, | |
5356 x for X11. | |
5357 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse | |
5358 pointer. | |
5359 | |
5360 Example: > | |
5361 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no | |
5362 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and | |
5363 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since | |
5364 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.) | |
5365 | |
5366 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'* | |
5367 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500) | |
5368 global | |
18972 | 5369 Only for GUI, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum |
7 | 5370 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be |
5371 recognized as a multi click. | |
5372 | |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5373 *'mzschemedll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5374 'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5375 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5376 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5377 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5378 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5379 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5380 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
12785 | 5381 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
5382 startup, before the |load-plugins| step. |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5383 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5384 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5385 |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5386 *'mzschemegcdll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5387 'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5388 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5389 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5390 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5391 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5392 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5393 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5394 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5395 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5396 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5397 |
14 | 5398 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'* |
5399 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100) | |
5400 global | |
5401 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme| | |
5402 feature} | |
5403 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads. | |
5404 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling. | |
11160 | 5405 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
5406 is reset. | |
14 | 5407 |
7 | 5408 *'nrformats'* *'nf'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5409 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex", |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5410 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 5411 local to buffer |
5412 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the | |
5413 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number | |
5414 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands. | |
625 | 5415 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be |
7 | 5416 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5417 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats* |
625 | 5418 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered |
7 | 5419 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010". |
625 | 5420 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be |
7 | 5421 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
5422 "0x100" results in "0x0ff". | |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5423 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5424 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5425 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111". |
7 | 5426 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always |
5427 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not | |
5428 recognized as octal or hex. | |
5429 | |
5430 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'* | |
5431 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off) | |
5432 local to window | |
5433 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is | |
5434 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of | |
5435 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set). | |
13 | 5436 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
5437 number. | |
7 | 5438 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
5439 characters are put before the number. | |
3445 | 5440 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5441 the number. | |
4780 | 5442 *number_relativenumber* |
5443 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be | |
5444 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these | |
5445 four combinations (cursor in line 3): | |
5446 | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5447 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu' |
4780 | 5448 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu' |
5449 | |
5450 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple | |
5451 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear | |
5452 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody | |
5453 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there | |
7 | 5454 |
13 | 5455 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'* |
5456 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8) | |
5457 local to window | |
14 | 5458 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak| |
5459 feature} | |
13 | 5460 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5461 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5462 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5463 the text, there is one less character for the number itself. |
13 | 5464 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5465 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5466 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5467 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5468 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used. |
17229
f1c7b7a4d9e4
patch 8.1.1614: 'numberwidth' can only go up to 10
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17161
diff
changeset
|
5469 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 20. |
11160 | 5470 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
5471 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
13 | 5472 |
523 | 5473 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'* |
5474 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty) | |
502 | 5475 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5476 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
17809
59f8948b7590
patch 8.1.1901: the +insert_expand feature is not always available
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17771
diff
changeset
|
5477 feature} |
623 | 5478 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni |
5479 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O| | |
648 | 5480 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
5481 invoked and what it should return. | |
1004 | 5482 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin: |
859 | 5483 |:filetype-plugin-on| |
3682 | 5484 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5485 security reasons. | |
502 | 5486 |
5487 | |
1152 | 5488 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'* |
1004 | 5489 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off) |
5490 global | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
5491 {only for MS-Windows} |
1004 | 5492 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a |
5493 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore | |
5494 it is off by default. | |
5495 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also | |
5496 result in editing a device. | |
5497 | |
5498 | |
593 | 5499 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'* |
5500 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty) | |
5501 global | |
5502 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator. | |
5503 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. | |
5504 | |
5505 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5506 security reasons. | |
5507 | |
5508 | |
2908 | 5509 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* |
5510 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "") | |
7 | 5511 local to buffer |
2908 | 5512 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed. |
5513 | |
7 | 5514 |
8182
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5515 *'packpath'* *'pp'* |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5516 'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath') |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5517 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|. |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5518 |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5519 |
7 | 5520 *'paragraphs'* *'para'* |
1564 | 5521 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp") |
7 | 5522 global |
5523 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs | |
5524 of two letters (see |object-motions|). | |
5525 | |
5526 *'paste'* *'nopaste'* | |
5527 'paste' boolean (default off) | |
5528 global | |
10 | 5529 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy |
5530 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid | |
7 | 5531 unexpected effects. |
5532 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim | |
10 | 5533 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim |
7 | 5534 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste' |
5535 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the | |
5536 mouse clicks itself. | |
148 | 5537 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in |
5538 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting | |
5539 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button | |
5540 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping. | |
7 | 5541 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on): |
5542 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled | |
5543 - abbreviations are disabled | |
5544 - 'autoindent' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5545 - 'expandtab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5546 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty |
7 | 5547 - 'revins' is reset |
5548 - 'ruler' is reset | |
5549 - 'showmatch' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5550 - 'smartindent' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5551 - 'smarttab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5552 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5553 - 'textwidth' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5554 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0 |
7 | 5555 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled: |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5556 - 'cindent' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5557 - 'indentexpr' |
7 | 5558 - 'lisp' |
5559 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is | |
5560 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the | |
5561 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to | |
5562 set the 'paste' option again. | |
5563 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to | |
5564 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on. | |
5565 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect. | |
5566 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use | |
5567 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key. | |
5568 | |
5569 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'* | |
5570 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "") | |
5571 global | |
5572 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste' | |
5573 option. This is like specifying a mapping: > | |
5574 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR> | |
5575 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'. | |
5576 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set. | |
5577 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in | |
5578 Command-line mode. | |
5579 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However, | |
5580 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do | |
5581 this: > | |
5582 :map <F10> :set paste<CR> | |
5583 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR> | |
5584 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR> | |
5585 :imap <F11> <nop> | |
5586 :set pastetoggle=<F11> | |
5587 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode. | |
5588 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste | |
5589 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key | |
5590 sequence. | |
1621 | 5591 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies. |
7 | 5592 |
5593 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'* | |
5594 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "") | |
5595 global | |
5596 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
5597 feature} | |
5598 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate | |
10 | 5599 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|. |
7 | 5600 |
6091
7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6032
diff
changeset
|
5601 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206* |
7 | 5602 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "") |
5603 global | |
5604 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used | |
5605 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a | |
5606 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a | |
5607 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the | |
5608 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option | |
5609 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like | |
13100
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5610 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5611 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5612 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5613 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5614 empty file is created. |
7 | 5615 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made. |
5616 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the | |
5617 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always | |
5618 recognized as a compressed file. | |
36 | 5619 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 5620 |
3224 | 5621 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854* |
7 | 5622 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,," |
5623 other systems: ".,,") | |
5624 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
5625 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
1668 | 5626 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands, |
5627 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not | |
5628 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path' | |
5629 option may be relative or absolute. | |
7 | 5630 - Use commas to separate directory names: > |
5631 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include | |
5632 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards | |
5633 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory | |
5634 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: > | |
5635 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space | |
5636 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra | |
5637 backslash: > | |
5638 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma | |
5639 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: > | |
5640 :set path=. | |
5641 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two | |
5642 commas: > | |
5643 :set path=,, | |
5644 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'. | |
5645 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5646 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding | |
5647 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work. | |
1668 | 5648 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and |
5649 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax. | |
7 | 5650 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature} |
5651 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: > | |
5652 :set path=.,c:\\include | |
5653 < Or just use '/' instead: > | |
5654 :set path=.,c:/include | |
5655 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as | |
5656 the file! | |
10 | 5657 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly |
7 | 5658 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. |
5659 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of | |
5660 'path', see |:checkpath|. | |
5661 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
5662 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
5663 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: > | |
5664 :set path-= | |
5665 < To add the current directory use: > | |
5666 :set path+= | |
5667 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the | |
5668 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory | |
5669 names are separated with a semi-colon: > | |
5670 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g') | |
5671 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that | |
5672 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space. | |
5673 | |
12499 | 5674 *'perldll'* |
5675 'perldll' string (default depends on the build) | |
5676 global | |
5677 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn| | |
5678 feature} | |
5679 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is | |
5680 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. | |
5681 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5682 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5683 security reasons. | |
5684 | |
7 | 5685 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'* |
5686 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off) | |
5687 local to buffer | |
5688 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the | |
5689 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a | |
5690 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is | |
5691 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option | |
5692 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible | |
5693 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required. | |
1621 | 5694 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains |
5695 a Tab. | |
7 | 5696 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of |
5697 tabs and spaces. You might not like this. | |
11160 | 5698 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 5699 Also see 'copyindent'. |
5700 Use |:retab| to clean up white space. | |
5701 | |
5702 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'* | |
5703 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12) | |
5704 global | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5705 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5706 feature} |
7 | 5707 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated |
17431
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5708 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. Not used when |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5709 'previewpopup' is set. |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5710 |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5711 *'previewpopup'* *'pvp'* |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5712 'previewpopup' 'pvp' string (default empty) |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5713 global |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5714 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop| |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5715 or |+quickfix| feature} |
17431
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5716 When not empty a popup window is used for commands that would open a |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5717 preview window. See |preview-popup|. |
17767
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
5718 Not used for the insert completion info, add "popup" to |
c75da1064e33
patch 8.1.1880: cannot show extra info for completion in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17571
diff
changeset
|
5719 'completeopt' for that. |
7 | 5720 |
5721 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'* | |
5722 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590* | |
5723 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off) | |
5724 local to window | |
17771
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5725 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| |
4bd21046902b
patch 8.1.1882: cannot specify properties of the info popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17767
diff
changeset
|
5726 feature} |
10 | 5727 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option |
7 | 5728 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands |
5729 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc. | |
5730 | |
5731 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'* | |
5732 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty) | |
5733 global | |
5734 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5735 feature} | |
15 | 5736 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5737 See |pdev-option|. | |
36 | 5738 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5739 security reasons. | |
15 | 5740 |
5741 *'printencoding'* *'penc'* | |
14864 | 5742 'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems) |
7 | 5743 global |
5744 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5745 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5746 Sets the character encoding used when printing. |
5747 See |penc-option|. | |
7 | 5748 |
5749 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'* | |
14864 | 5750 'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below) |
7 | 5751 global |
5752 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5753 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5754 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|. |
5755 See |pexpr-option|. | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5756 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5757 security reasons. |
15 | 5758 |
5759 *'printfont'* *'pfn'* | |
7 | 5760 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier") |
5761 global | |
5762 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5763 feature} | |
15 | 5764 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5765 See |pfn-option|. | |
7 | 5766 |
5767 *'printheader'* *'pheader'* | |
5768 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N") | |
5769 global | |
5770 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5771 feature} | |
15 | 5772 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output. |
5773 See |pheader-option|. | |
5774 | |
5775 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'* | |
5776 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "") | |
5777 global | |
15878 | 5778 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5779 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5780 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5781 See |pmbcs-option|. | |
5782 | |
5783 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'* | |
5784 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "") | |
5785 global | |
15878 | 5786 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5787 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5788 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5789 See |pmbfn-option|. | |
7 | 5790 |
5791 *'printoptions'* *'popt'* | |
5792 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "") | |
5793 global | |
5794 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature} | |
15 | 5795 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|. |
5796 See |popt-option|. | |
5797 | |
168 | 5798 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'* |
5799 'prompt' boolean (default on) | |
5800 global | |
5801 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode. | |
5802 | |
766 | 5803 *'pumheight'* *'ph'* |
5804 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0) | |
5805 global | |
853 | 5806 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for |
5807 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used. | |
766 | 5808 |ins-completion-menu|. |
5809 | |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5810 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'* |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5811 'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15) |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5812 global |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5813 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5814 completion. |ins-completion-menu|. |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5815 |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5816 *'pythondll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5817 'pythondll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5818 global |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5819 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5820 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5821 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5822 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5823 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5824 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5825 security reasons. |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5826 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5827 *'pythonhome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5828 'pythonhome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5829 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5830 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5831 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5832 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome' |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5833 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5834 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5835 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5836 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5837 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5838 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5839 |
7218
36dc8df8560f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0796c0625fa4b9eb2f47fe8c976b78523924e1fb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7196
diff
changeset
|
5840 *'pythonthreedll'* |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5841 'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build) |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5842 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5843 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5844 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5845 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5846 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5847 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5848 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5849 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5850 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5851 *'pythonthreehome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5852 'pythonthreehome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5853 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5854 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5855 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5856 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5857 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5858 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5859 the Python 3 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5860 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5861 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5862 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5863 |
10722
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5864 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'* |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5865 'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build) |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5866 global |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5867 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5868 the |+python3| feature} |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5869 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5870 |python_x|. The default value is as follows: |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5871 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5872 Compiled with Default ~ |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5873 |+python| and |+python3| 0 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5874 only |+python| 2 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5875 only |+python3| 3 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5876 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5877 Available values are 0, 2 and 3. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5878 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5879 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3` |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5880 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5881 to 2 if Python 2 is available. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5882 See also: |has-pythonx| |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5883 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5884 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5885 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5886 always the same as the compiled version. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5887 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5888 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5889 security reasons. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5890 |
140 | 5891 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'* |
12 | 5892 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\") |
5893 local to buffer | |
5894 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for | |
5895 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|. | |
5896 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string, | |
5897 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the | |
5898 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string. | |
5899 | |
7 | 5900 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'* |
5901 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off) | |
5902 local to buffer | |
5903 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from | |
5904 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started | |
5905 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view". | |
164 | 5906 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current |
5907 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'. | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5908 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5909 newly edited buffer. |
10617 | 5910 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer. |
7 | 5911 |
1521 | 5912 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'* |
5913 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000) | |
5914 global | |
5915 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| | |
5916 feature} | |
5917 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
5918 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5919 highlighting. |
1521 | 5920 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5921 matches will be highlighted. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5922 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5923 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5924 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5925 pattern. |
1521 | 5926 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5927 *'regexpengine'* *'re'* |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5928 'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0) |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5929 global |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5930 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines| |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5931 The possible values are: |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5932 0 automatic selection |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5933 1 old engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5934 2 NFA engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5935 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5936 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5937 for debugging the regexp engine. |
6328 | 5938 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the |
5939 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too | |
5940 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of | |
5941 a complex pattern with long text. | |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5942 |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5943 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'* |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5944 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off) |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5945 local to window |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5946 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2204
diff
changeset
|
5947 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5948 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5949 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5950 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5951 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5952 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5953 'compatible' isn't set). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5954 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5955 number. |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5956 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5957 characters are put before the number. |
3445 | 5958 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5959 the number. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5960 |
4780 | 5961 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of |
5962 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two | |
5963 options. | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5964 |
7 | 5965 *'remap'* *'noremap'* |
5966 'remap' boolean (default on) | |
5967 global | |
5968 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for | |
5969 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command. | |
717 | 5970 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep |
5971 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with | |
5972 old Vi scripts. | |
7 | 5973 |
6110 | 5974 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'* |
5975 'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty) | |
5976 global | |
5977 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on | |
5978 MS-Windows} | |
5979 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the | |
5980 renderer. | |
5981 | |
5982 Syntax: > | |
5983 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})* | |
5984 < | |
5985 Currently, only one optional renderer is available. | |
5986 | |
5987 render behavior ~ | |
5988 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes | |
5989 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI. | |
5990 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on | |
5991 MS-Windows Vista or newer version. | |
5992 | |
5993 Options: | |
5994 name meaning type value ~ | |
5995 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe) | |
5996 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown) | |
5997 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown) | |
5998 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below) | |
5999 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below) | |
6000 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below) | |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
6001 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated) |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6002 |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6003 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines): |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6004 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx |
6110 | 6005 |
6006 For geom: structure of a device pixel. | |
6007 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT | |
6008 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB | |
6009 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR | |
6010 | |
6011 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6012 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx |
6110 | 6013 |
6014 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs. | |
6015 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT | |
6016 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED | |
6017 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC | |
6018 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL | |
6019 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL | |
6020 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC | |
6021 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE | |
6022 | |
6023 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6024 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx |
6110 | 6025 |
6026 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text. | |
6027 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT | |
6028 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE | |
6029 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE | |
6030 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED | |
6031 | |
6032 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6033 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6034 |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
6035 For scrlines: |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
6036 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
6037 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored. |
6110 | 6038 |
6039 Example: > | |
6040 set encoding=utf-8 | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6041 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12 |
6110 | 6042 set rop=type:directx |
6043 < | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6044 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6045 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6046 drawn by GDI as a fallback. |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6047 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6048 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6049 causes trouble on drawing glyphs. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6050 |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
6051 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6052 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6053 bitmap glyphs). |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6054 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6055 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6056 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6057 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6058 there are some conditions which you should notice. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6059 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6060 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6061 be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6062 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6063 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji" |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6064 will be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6065 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6066 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6067 cell. |
6110 | 6068 |
6069 Other render types are currently not supported. | |
6070 | |
7 | 6071 *'report'* |
6072 'report' number (default 2) | |
6073 global | |
6074 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of | |
6075 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most | |
6076 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0. | |
6077 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used | |
6078 instead of the number of lines. | |
6079 | |
6080 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'* | |
6081 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on) | |
6082 global | |
19116 | 6083 {only in MS-Windows console version} |
7 | 6084 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also |
6085 happens when executing external commands. | |
6086 | |
6087 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te' | |
6088 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring: | |
6089 set t_ti= t_te= | |
6090 To enable restoring (for an xterm): | |
6091 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8 | |
6092 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it) | |
6093 | |
6094 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'* | |
6095 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off) | |
6096 global | |
6097 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6098 feature} | |
6099 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing | |
6100 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_ | |
6101 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6102 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6103 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6104 reset. |
7 | 6105 |
6106 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'* | |
6107 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off) | |
6108 local to window | |
6109 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6110 feature} | |
6111 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters | |
6112 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left. | |
6113 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that | |
6114 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic. | |
6115 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files | |
6116 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is | |
6117 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left | |
6118 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly | |
6119 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|. | |
6120 | |
2341 | 6121 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* |
7 | 6122 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search") |
6123 local to window | |
6124 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6125 feature} | |
6126 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in | |
6127 right-to-left mode for a group of commands: | |
6128 | |
6129 search "/" and "?" commands | |
6130 | |
6131 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi. | |
6132 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect. | |
6133 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6134 *'rubydll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
6135 'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6136 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6137 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6138 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6139 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6140 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
6141 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6142 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6143 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6144 |
7 | 6145 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6146 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6147 global |
6148 {not available when compiled without the | |
6149 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
6150 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a | |
10 | 6151 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed |
7 | 6152 text in the file is shown on the far right: |
6153 Top first line is visible | |
6154 Bot last line is visible | |
6155 All first and last line are visible | |
6156 45% relative position in the file | |
6157 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler. | |
10 | 6158 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the |
7 | 6159 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the |
233 | 6160 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty), |
7 | 6161 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat' |
6162 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of | |
6163 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both | |
6164 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown, | |
6165 separated with a dash. | |
6166 For an empty line "0-1" is shown. | |
6167 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1". | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6168 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6169 reset. |
7 | 6170 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where |
6171 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|. | |
6172 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6173 | |
6174 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'* | |
6175 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty) | |
6176 global | |
6177 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| | |
6178 feature} | |
6179 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler | |
6180 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option. | |
692 | 6181 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6182 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6183 |
7 | 6184 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15 |
6185 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end. | |
6186 Example: > | |
6187 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%) | |
6188 < | |
6189 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles* | |
6190 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default: | |
6191 Unix: "$HOME/.vim, | |
6192 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6193 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6194 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6195 $HOME/.vim/after" | |
6196 Amiga: "home:vimfiles, | |
6197 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6198 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6199 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6200 home:vimfiles/after" | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
6201 PC: "$HOME/vimfiles, |
7 | 6202 $VIM/vimfiles, |
6203 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6204 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6205 $HOME/vimfiles/after" | |
6206 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles, | |
6207 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6208 $VIM:vimfiles:after" | |
6209 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles, | |
6210 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6211 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6212 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
233 | 6213 sys$login:vimfiles/after") |
7 | 6214 global |
6215 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime | |
6216 files: | |
6217 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype| | |
6218 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts| | |
164 | 6219 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions| |
7 | 6220 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme| |
6221 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler| | |
6222 doc/ documentation |write-local-help| | |
6223 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin| | |
19181
94eda51ba9ba
patch 8.2.0149: maintaining a Vim9 branch separately is more work
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
19180
diff
changeset
|
6224 import/ files that are found by `:import` |
7 | 6225 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression| |
6226 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap| | |
6227 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans| | |
6228 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim| | |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6229 pack/ packages |:packadd| |
7 | 6230 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin| |
6231 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding| | |
650 | 6232 spell/ spell checking files |spell| |
7 | 6233 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile| |
6234 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor| | |
6235 | |
6236 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command. | |
6237 | |
6238 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations: | |
6239 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences. | |
6240 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system | |
6241 administrator. | |
6242 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim. | |
6243 *after-directory* | |
6244 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is | |
6245 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed | |
6246 defaults (rarely needed) | |
6247 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for | |
6248 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults | |
6249 or system-wide settings (rarely needed). | |
6250 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6251 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6252 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6253 string. |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6254 |
7 | 6255 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal |
6256 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for | |
10 | 6257 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid |
7 | 6258 wildcards. |
6259 See |:runtime|. | |
6260 Example: > | |
6261 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME | |
6262 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your | |
6263 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a | |
6264 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime | |
6265 files). | |
6266 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the | |
6267 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME | |
6268 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put | |
6269 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed | |
6270 runtime files. | |
13437 | 6271 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not |
6272 included. | |
7 | 6273 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6274 security reasons. | |
6275 | |
6276 *'scroll'* *'scr'* | |
6277 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height) | |
6278 local to window | |
6279 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be | |
6280 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size | |
6281 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will | |
10 | 6282 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
6283 height with ":set scroll=0". |
7 | 6284 |
6285 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'* | |
6286 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off) | |
6287 local to window | |
6288 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current | |
6289 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have | |
6290 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the | |
6291 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'. | |
6292 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be | |
6293 interpreted. | |
6294 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another | |
6295 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows | |
6296 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not. | |
6297 | |
18526
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6298 *'scrollfocus'* *'scf'* *'noscrollfocus'* *'noscf'* |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6299 'scrollfocus' 'scf' boolean (default off) |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6300 global |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6301 {only for MS-Windows GUI} |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6302 When using the scroll wheel and this option is set, the window under |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6303 the mouse pointer is scrolled. With this option off the current |
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6304 window is scrolled. |
18594 | 6305 Systems other than MS-Windows always behave like this option is on. |
18526
334b1f897f3a
patch 8.1.2257: MS-Windows GUI: scroll wheel always uses current window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18489
diff
changeset
|
6306 |
7 | 6307 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'* |
6308 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1) | |
6309 global | |
6310 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the | |
6311 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E, | |
6312 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly. | |
532 | 6313 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the |
6314 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window | |
6315 height. | |
7 | 6316 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set. |
6317 | |
6318 *'scrolloff'* *'so'* | |
10218
584c835a2de1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/50ba526fbf3e9e5e0e6b0b3086a4d5df581ebc7e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10211
diff
changeset
|
6319 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|) |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6320 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6321 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor. |
6322 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If | |
6323 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be | |
6324 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or | |
6325 when long lines wrap). | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6326 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6327 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6328 setlocal scrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6329 setlocal scrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6330 < For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'. |
7 | 6331 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
6332 | |
6333 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'* | |
6334 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump") | |
6335 global | |
6336 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how | |
236 | 6337 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind |
6338 Options. | |
7 | 6339 The following words are available: |
6340 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6341 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6342 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical | |
6343 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first | |
6344 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving | |
6345 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may | |
6346 reach a position before the start or after the end of | |
6347 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when | |
6348 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll | |
6349 to the desired position when possible. | |
6350 When now making that window the current one, two | |
6351 things can be done with the relative offset: | |
6352 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is | |
6353 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current | |
6354 window. When going back to the other window, the | |
1152 | 6355 new relative offset will be used. |
7 | 6356 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are |
6357 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When | |
6358 going back to the other window, it still uses the | |
6359 same relative offset. | |
6360 Also see |scroll-binding|. | |
819 | 6361 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding, |
6362 even when "ver" isn't there. | |
7 | 6363 |
6364 *'sections'* *'sect'* | |
6365 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh") | |
6366 global | |
6367 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of | |
6368 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start | |
6369 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh". | |
6370 | |
6371 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523* | |
6372 'secure' boolean (default off) | |
6373 global | |
6374 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in | |
6375 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are | |
6376 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into | |
6377 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is | |
6378 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be | |
10 | 6379 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set |
7 | 6380 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then. |
6381 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6382 security reasons. | |
6383 | |
6384 *'selection'* *'sel'* | |
6385 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive") | |
6386 global | |
6387 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used | |
6388 in Visual and Select mode. | |
6389 Possible values: | |
6390 value past line inclusive ~ | |
6391 old no yes | |
6392 inclusive yes yes | |
6393 exclusive yes no | |
6394 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one | |
6395 character past the line. | |
6396 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included | |
6397 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the | |
6398 selection. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6399 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6400 the end of line the line break still isn't included. |
7 | 6401 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end |
6402 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when | |
6403 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty. | |
6404 | |
6405 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6406 | |
6407 *'selectmode'* *'slm'* | |
6408 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "") | |
6409 global | |
6410 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start | |
6411 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started. | |
6412 Possible values: | |
6413 mouse when using the mouse | |
6414 key when using shifted special keys | |
6415 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V | |
6416 See |Select-mode|. | |
6417 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6418 | |
6419 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'* | |
6420 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds, | |
13437 | 6421 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal") |
7 | 6422 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6423 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 6424 feature} |
6425 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma | |
6426 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring | |
6427 something: | |
6428 word save and restore ~ | |
6429 blank empty windows | |
6430 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows | |
6431 curdir the current directory | |
6432 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
6433 fold options | |
6434 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter | |
75 | 6435 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only |
6436 String and Number types are stored. | |
7 | 6437 help the help window |
6438 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
6439 global values for local options) | |
6440 options all options and mappings (also global values for local | |
6441 options) | |
6442 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns' | |
6443 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located | |
6444 will become the current directory (useful with | |
6445 projects accessed over a network from different | |
6446 systems) | |
6447 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward | |
6448 slashes | |
827 | 6449 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page |
6450 is restored, so that you can make a session for each | |
6451 tab page separately | |
14519 | 6452 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be |
6453 restored | |
7 | 6454 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when |
6455 on Windows or DOS | |
6456 winpos position of the whole Vim window | |
6457 winsize window sizes | |
6458 | |
6459 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir". | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6460 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6461 with absolute paths. |
7 | 6462 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files |
6463 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
6464 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
6465 | |
6466 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91* | |
18928 | 6467 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", Win32: "cmd.exe") |
7 | 6468 global |
6469 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the | |
6470 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash' | |
6471 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'. | |
10 | 6472 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f". |
7 | 6473 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
6474 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6475 |
18489 | 6476 If the name of the shell contains a space, you need to enclose it in |
18594 | 6477 quotes and escape the space. Example with quotes: > |
7 | 6478 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f |
6479 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and | |
10 | 6480 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the |
7 | 6481 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6482 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path |
7 | 6483 separators. |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6484 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6485 option from $SHELL): > |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6486 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh |
14519 | 6487 < The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6488 backslashes are consumed by `:set`. |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6489 |
7 | 6490 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be |
6491 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com" | |
6492 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g., | |
6493 filtering). | |
6494 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is | |
6495 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: > | |
6496 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos | |
6497 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6498 security reasons. | |
6499 | |
6500 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'* | |
3356 | 6501 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c"; |
18972 | 6502 Win32, when 'shell' does not contain "sh" |
6503 somewhere: "/c") | |
7 | 6504 global |
6505 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g., | |
19116 | 6506 "bash.exe -c ls" or "cmd.exe /c dir". For MS-Windows, the default is |
6507 set according to the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this | |
6508 option by the user. | |
3082 | 6509 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated |
6510 part is passed as an argument to the shell command. | |
6511 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
18972 | 6512 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-Windows. |
7 | 6513 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6514 security reasons. | |
6515 | |
6516 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'* | |
19116 | 6517 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", ">%s 2>&1", "| tee", "|& tee" or |
6518 "2>&1| tee") | |
7 | 6519 global |
6520 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
6521 feature} | |
6522 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the | |
10 | 6523 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about |
7 | 6524 including spaces and backslashes. |
6525 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6526 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6527 of this option). | |
19116 | 6528 For the Amiga the default is ">". For MS-Windows the default is |
6529 ">%s 2>&1". The output is directly saved in a file and not echoed to | |
6530 the screen. | |
7 | 6531 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved |
6532 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or | |
6533 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the | |
18456 | 6534 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta", |
6535 "bash" or "fish" the default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that | |
6536 stderr is also included. Before using the 'shell' option a path is | |
6537 removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses "sh". | |
7 | 6538 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" |
6539 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6540 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was | |
6541 explicitly set before. | |
6542 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the | |
6543 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg' | |
6544 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do | |
6545 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space. | |
6546 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ". | |
6547 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6548 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6549 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6550 security reasons. | |
6551 | |
6552 *'shellquote'* *'shq'* | |
18972 | 6553 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; Win32, when 'shell' |
7 | 6554 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"") |
6555 global | |
6556 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6557 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the | |
6558 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's | |
6559 probably not useful to set both options. | |
6560 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for | |
18972 | 6561 third-party shells on MS-Windows-like systems, such as the MKS Korn |
6562 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted | |
6563 according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option | |
6564 by the user. See |dos-shell|. | |
7 | 6565 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6566 security reasons. | |
6567 | |
6568 *'shellredir'* *'srr'* | |
6569 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1") | |
6570 global | |
6571 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary | |
6572 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces | |
6573 and backslashes. | |
6574 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6575 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6576 of this option). | |
18456 | 6577 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh" or |
6578 "tcsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the | |
18719 | 6579 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta", |
6580 "bash" or "fish", the default becomes ">%s 2>&1". This means that | |
6581 stderr is also included. For Win32, the Unix checks are done and | |
6582 additionally "cmd" is checked for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". | |
6583 Also, the same names with ".exe" appended are checked for. | |
7 | 6584 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" |
6585 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6586 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was | |
6587 explicitly set before. | |
6588 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6589 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6590 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6591 security reasons. | |
6592 | |
6593 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'* | |
6594 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off) | |
6595 global | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
6596 {only for MS-Windows} |
7 | 6597 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is |
19116 | 6598 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of cmd.exe. Backward |
6599 slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to forward slashes by | |
6600 Vim. | |
7 | 6601 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some |
6602 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening | |
6603 any file for best results. This might change in the future. | |
6604 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path | |
6605 separator. To test if this is so use: > | |
6606 if exists('+shellslash') | |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
6607 < Also see 'completeslash'. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
6608 |
168 | 6609 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'* |
6610 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on) | |
6611 global | |
6612 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe. | |
6613 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway. | |
2965 | 6614 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and |
6615 later. You can check it with: > | |
168 | 6616 :if has("filterpipe") |
6617 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file | |
6618 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection. | |
6619 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding | |
6620 can be detected. | |
6621 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|, | |
6622 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when | |
6623 'shelltemp' is off. | |
9533
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6624 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses |
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6625 temp files. |
11160 | 6626 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
6627 is reset. | |
168 | 6628 |
7 | 6629 *'shelltype'* *'st'* |
6630 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0) | |
6631 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6632 {only for the Amiga} |
7 | 6633 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work |
6634 which use a shell. | |
6635 0 and 1: always use the shell | |
6636 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines | |
6637 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command | |
6638 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly. | |
6639 | |
6640 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands | |
6641 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands | |
6642 | |
3371 | 6643 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'* |
6644 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: ""; | |
18972 | 6645 for MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^") |
3371 | 6646 global |
6647 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this | |
6648 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible | |
6649 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe. | |
6650 | |
7 | 6651 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'* |
6652 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: ""; | |
3359 | 6653 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "(" |
6654 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh" | |
6655 somewhere: "\"" | |
7 | 6656 for Unix, when using system(): "\"") |
6657 global | |
6658 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6659 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See | |
6660 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful | |
6661 to set both options. | |
3359 | 6662 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"(' |
6663 then ')"' is appended. | |
6664 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'. | |
3352 | 6665 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be |
6666 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically | |
6667 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells | |
6668 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The | |
6669 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need | |
6670 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|. | |
7 | 6671 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6672 security reasons. | |
6673 | |
6674 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'* | |
6675 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off) | |
6676 global | |
6677 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and < | |
6678 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to | |
6679 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible). | |
6680 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6681 | |
6682 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'* | |
6683 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8) | |
6684 local to buffer | |
10 | 6685 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for |
7 | 6686 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc. |
3893 | 6687 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()| |
6688 function to get the effective shiftwidth value. | |
7 | 6689 |
6690 *'shortmess'* *'shm'* | |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6691 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToOS", Vi default: "S", |
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6692 POSIX default: "AS") |
7 | 6693 global |
6694 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file | |
6695 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages. | |
6696 It is a list of flags: | |
6697 flag meaning when present ~ | |
6698 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)" | |
6699 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]" | |
6700 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters" | |
6701 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]" | |
6702 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]" | |
6703 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]" | |
6704 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message | |
6705 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command | |
6706 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of | |
6707 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]". | |
6708 a all of the above abbreviations | |
6709 | |
6710 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message | |
6711 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on) | |
6712 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message. | |
6713 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn"). | |
6714 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search | |
16610 | 6715 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages; when using the search |
6716 count do not show "W" after the count message (see S below) | |
7 | 6717 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit |
6718 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column. | |
6719 Ignored in Ex mode. | |
6720 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to | |
233 | 6721 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle. |
7 | 6722 Ignored in Ex mode. |
6723 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file | |
6724 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file | |
6725 is found. | |
6726 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|. | |
5946 | 6727 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example, |
6728 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match", | |
6729 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc. | |
8560
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6730 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a" |
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6731 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent` |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6732 was used for the command; note that this also affects messages |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6733 from autocommands |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6734 S do not show search count message when searching, e.g. |
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6735 "[1/5]" |
7 | 6736 |
6737 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers | |
6738 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as | |
6739 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you | |
6740 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!" | |
6741 Useful values: | |
6742 shm= No abbreviation of message. | |
6743 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information. | |
6744 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary. | |
6745 | |
6746 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6747 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6748 | |
6749 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'* | |
6750 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off) | |
6751 local to buffer | |
6752 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3 | |
6753 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this | |
6754 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when | |
18972 | 6755 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is useful |
7 | 6756 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos |
19163 | 6757 or crossdos. |
7 | 6758 |
6759 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595* | |
6760 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "") | |
18574
8b0114ffde2b
patch 8.1.2281: 'showbreak' cannot be set for one window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18526
diff
changeset
|
6761 global or local to window |global-local| |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6762 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 6763 feature} |
6764 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6765 values are "> " or "+++ ": > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6766 :set showbreak=>\ |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6767 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6768 this: > |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
6769 :let &showbreak = '+++ ' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6770 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and |
7 | 6771 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the |
6772 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line). | |
6773 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in | |
6774 'highlight'. | |
6775 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently. | |
6776 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the | |
6777 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'. | |
18574
8b0114ffde2b
patch 8.1.2281: 'showbreak' cannot be set for one window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18526
diff
changeset
|
6778 A window-local value overrules a global value. If the global value is |
8b0114ffde2b
patch 8.1.2281: 'showbreak' cannot be set for one window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18526
diff
changeset
|
6779 set and you want no value in the current window use NONE: > |
8b0114ffde2b
patch 8.1.2281: 'showbreak' cannot be set for one window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18526
diff
changeset
|
6780 :setlocal showbreak=NONE |
8b0114ffde2b
patch 8.1.2281: 'showbreak' cannot be set for one window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18526
diff
changeset
|
6781 < |
7 | 6782 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6783 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6784 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6785 global |
6786 {not available when compiled without the | |
6787 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
1152 | 6788 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this |
6789 option off if your terminal is slow. | |
7 | 6790 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown: |
6791 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters. | |
2324
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6792 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6" |
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6793 means two characters and six bytes. |
7 | 6794 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6795 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6796 {lines}x{columns}. |
7 | 6797 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
6798 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6799 | |
6800 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'* | |
6801 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off) | |
6802 global | |
6803 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the | |
6804 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search | |
10 | 6805 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have |
7 | 6806 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are |
6807 required (coding style permitting). | |
1621 | 6808 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in |
6809 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not | |
6810 match the typed text. | |
7 | 6811 |
6812 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'* | |
6813 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off) | |
6814 global | |
6815 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The | |
6816 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to | |
6817 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'. | |
6818 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6819 seen or not). |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6820 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6821 reset. |
7 | 6822 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character |
6823 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs. | |
6824 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and | |
6825 blinking when showing the match. | |
6826 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show | |
6827 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite | |
6828 matches. | |
699 | 6829 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving |
6830 around |pi_paren.txt|. | |
6831 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG. | |
7 | 6832 |
6833 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'* | |
6834 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
6835 global | |
6836 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line. | |
6837 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for | |
6838 this message. | |
10 | 6839 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this |
7 | 6840 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is |
6841 not set. | |
6842 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6843 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6844 | |
677 | 6845 *'showtabline'* *'stal'* |
6846 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1) | |
6847 global | |
6848 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels | |
6849 will be displayed: | |
6850 0: never | |
6851 1: only if there are at least two tab pages | |
6852 2: always | |
6853 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages | |
6854 line. | |
6855 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages. | |
6856 | |
7 | 6857 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'* |
6858 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0) | |
6859 global | |
6860 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when | |
6861 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen. | |
6862 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen. | |
6863 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using | |
6864 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl" | |
6865 commands. | |
6866 | |
6867 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'* | |
6868 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0) | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6869 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6870 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the |
534 | 6871 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a |
6872 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero | |
6873 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in | |
6874 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option | |
6875 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor | |
6876 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too | |
6877 close to the beginning of the line. | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6878 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6879 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6880 setlocal sidescrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6881 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6882 < NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 6883 |
6884 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as | |
6885 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6886 onto the "extends" character: > |
7 | 6887 |
6888 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:< | |
6889 :set sidescrolloff=1 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6890 < |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6891 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'* |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6892 'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto") |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6893 local to window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6894 {not available when compiled without the |+signs| |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6895 feature} |
9860
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6896 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are: |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6897 "auto" only when there is a sign to display |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6898 "no" never |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6899 "yes" always |
17129
4fb68abc770f
patch 8.1.1564: sign column takes up space
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16808
diff
changeset
|
6900 "number" display signs in the 'number' column. If the number |
17161 | 6901 column is not present, then behaves like "auto". |
7 | 6902 |
6903 | |
6904 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'* | |
6905 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off) | |
6906 global | |
6907 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper | |
6908 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and | |
6909 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N", | |
3557 | 6910 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After |
7 | 6911 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command, |
6912 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>. | |
6913 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6914 | |
6915 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'* | |
6916 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off) | |
6917 local to buffer | |
6918 {not available when compiled without the | |
6919 |+smartindent| feature} | |
6920 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like | |
6921 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does | |
6922 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict, | |
2662 | 6923 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set, |
2642 | 6924 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced |
6925 alternative. | |
7 | 6926 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'. |
6927 An indent is automatically inserted: | |
6928 - After a line ending in '{'. | |
6929 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'. | |
6930 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command). | |
6931 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is | |
6932 given the same indent as the matching '{'. | |
6933 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for | |
6934 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent | |
10 | 6935 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this |
7 | 6936 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H. |
6937 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted | |
6938 right. | |
11160 | 6939 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6940 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6941 reset. |
7 | 6942 |
6943 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'* | |
6944 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off) | |
6945 global | |
6946 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to | |
648 | 6947 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A |
6948 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the | |
6949 line. | |
650 | 6950 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or |
648 | 6951 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or |
6952 right |shift-left-right|. | |
1263 | 6953 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab' |
7 | 6954 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the |
11 | 6955 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6956 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6957 reset. |
7 | 6958 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6959 | |
6960 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'* | |
6961 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0) | |
6962 local to buffer | |
6963 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing | |
6964 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like | |
6965 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is | |
6966 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value | |
6967 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However, | |
6968 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters. | |
6969 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off. | |
3893 | 6970 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6971 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6972 when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 6973 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of |
6974 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. | |
6975 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is | |
6976 set. | |
6977 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
6978 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6979 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6980 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6981 anything other than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6982 |
221 | 6983 *'spell'* *'nospell'* |
6984 'spell' boolean (default off) | |
6985 local to window | |
6986 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6987 feature} | |
6988 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|. | |
236 | 6989 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'. |
221 | 6990 |
386 | 6991 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'* |
389 | 6992 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+") |
386 | 6993 local to buffer |
6994 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6995 feature} | |
6996 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be | |
6997 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted | |
484 | 6998 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled). |
386 | 6999 When this check is not wanted make this option empty. |
7000 Only used when 'spell' is set. | |
389 | 7001 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about |
7002 including spaces and backslashes. | |
480 | 7003 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see |
7004 |set-spc-auto|. | |
386 | 7005 |
314 | 7006 *'spellfile'* *'spf'* |
7007 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty) | |
7008 local to buffer | |
7009 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7010 feature} | |
7011 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw| | |
401 | 7012 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the |
7013 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory. | |
386 | 7014 *E765* |
7015 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the | |
7016 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using | |
7017 a personal word list file and a project word list file. | |
314 | 7018 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for |
819 | 7019 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If |
7020 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file | |
7021 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used, | |
353 | 7022 ignoring the region. |
7023 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not | |
7024 have to appear in 'spelllang'. | |
7025 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region | |
7026 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when | |
7027 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files | |
7028 without region name will be found. | |
336 | 7029 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7030 security reasons. | |
314 | 7031 |
221 | 7032 *'spelllang'* *'spl'* |
314 | 7033 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en") |
221 | 7034 local to buffer |
7035 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7036 feature} | |
353 | 7037 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is |
7038 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: > | |
7039 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical | |
7040 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words | |
7041 that are not recognized will be highlighted. | |
16380 | 7042 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or |
7043 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is | |
353 | 7044 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a |
7045 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words. | |
7046 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is | |
7047 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one | |
7048 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian | |
7049 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
7050 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
7051 en_ca, en_gb and en_us). |
5477 | 7052 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from |
7053 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian | |
7054 words. | |
484 | 7055 *E757* |
419 | 7056 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The |
7057 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name | |
7058 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter). | |
7059 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct | |
7060 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it. | |
236 | 7061 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good |
419 | 7062 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the |
7063 files twice. | |
353 | 7064 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|. |
221 | 7065 |
653 | 7066 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name |
7067 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin | |
7068 will ask you if you want to download the file. | |
7069 | |
480 | 7070 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files |
7071 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang' | |
15068 | 7072 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and |
7073 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|. | |
480 | 7074 |
7075 | |
344 | 7076 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'* |
7077 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best") | |
7078 global | |
7079 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7080 feature} | |
593 | 7081 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and |
374 | 7082 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of |
7083 items: | |
7084 | |
7085 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds | |
7086 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like | |
7087 scoring to improve the ordering. | |
7088 | |
7089 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the | |
7090 results. The first method is "fast", the other method | |
344 | 7091 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad |
374 | 7092 word. That only works when the language specifies |
7093 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give | |
7094 better results. | |
7095 | |
7096 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes: | |
7097 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for | |
7098 simple typing mistakes. | |
7099 | |
593 | 7100 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|. |
484 | 7101 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of |
7102 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines' | |
7103 minus two. | |
7104 | |
374 | 7105 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns, |
7106 separated by a slash. The first column contains the | |
7107 bad word, the second column the suggested good word. | |
7108 Example: | |
7109 theribal/terrible ~ | |
7110 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the | |
7111 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods. | |
7112 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for | |
7113 comments. | |
5862 | 7114 The word in the second column must be correct, |
7115 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an | |
7116 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling | |
7117 mistake. | |
374 | 7118 The file is used for all languages. |
7119 | |
7120 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid | |
7121 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled | |
7122 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of | |
7123 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score. | |
7124 Example: | |
11062 | 7125 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~ |
593 | 7126 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the |
374 | 7127 internal methods use. A lower score is better. |
7128 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily | |
7129 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part. | |
7130 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the | |
7131 'verbose' option to a non-zero value. | |
7132 | |
7133 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may | |
7134 appear several times in any order. Example: > | |
7135 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest() | |
7136 < | |
7137 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
7138 security reasons. | |
344 | 7139 |
7140 | |
7 | 7141 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'* |
7142 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off) | |
7143 global | |
7144 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current | |
7145 one. |:split| | |
7146 | |
7147 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'* | |
7148 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off) | |
7149 global | |
7150 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the | |
7151 current one. |:vsplit| | |
7152 | |
7153 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'* | |
7154 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on) | |
7155 global | |
7156 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first | |
11 | 7157 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column |
10 | 7158 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B, |
11 | 7159 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>" |
7 | 7160 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing |
7161 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that | |
7162 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+". | |
7163 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column | |
7164 where it was the last time the buffer was edited. | |
7165 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
7166 | |
2709 | 7167 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542* |
7 | 7168 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty) |
40 | 7169 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 7170 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| |
7171 feature} | |
7172 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line. | |
7173 Also see |status-line|. | |
7174 | |
7175 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with | |
7176 normal text. Each status line item is of the form: | |
7177 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item} | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
7178 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can |
2709 | 7179 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541* |
7 | 7180 |
680 | 7181 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression, |
7182 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: > | |
7183 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine() | |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7184 < The *g:statusline_winid* variable will be set to the |window-ID| of the |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7185 window that the status line belongs to. |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7186 The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too. |
3445 | 7187 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the |
7188 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the | |
7189 context of the window that the statusline belongs to. | |
680 | 7190 |
7191 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made | |
7192 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop. | |
7193 | |
7 | 7194 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and |
7195 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|. | |
7196 | |
7197 field meaning ~ | |
233 | 7198 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified |
7 | 7199 when minwid is larger than the length of the item. |
233 | 7200 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'. |
7 | 7201 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'. |
7202 Value must be 50 or less. | |
10 | 7203 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<' |
7 | 7204 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be |
7205 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number | |
7206 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like | |
7207 an exponential notation. | |
7208 item A one letter code as described below. | |
7209 | |
7210 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The | |
7211 second character in "item" is the type: | |
7212 N for number | |
7213 S for string | |
7214 F for flags as described below | |
7215 - not applicable | |
7216 | |
7217 item meaning ~ | |
1152 | 7218 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current |
7219 directory. | |
7 | 7220 F S Full path to the file in the buffer. |
7221 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer. | |
1698 | 7222 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off. |
7 | 7223 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-". |
1698 | 7224 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]". |
7 | 7225 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO". |
1698 | 7226 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]". |
7 | 7227 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP". |
1698 | 7228 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]". |
7 | 7229 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV". |
1698 | 7230 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'. |
7 | 7231 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'. |
2411
68e394361ca3
Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2400
diff
changeset
|
7232 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty. |
7 | 7233 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are |
7234 being used: "<keymap>" | |
7235 n N Buffer number. | |
2709 | 7236 b N Value of character under cursor. |
7 | 7237 B N As above, in hexadecimal. |
7238 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1. | |
7239 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added) | |
7240 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature} | |
7241 O N As above, in hexadecimal. | |
233 | 7242 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.) |
7 | 7243 l N Line number. |
7244 L N Number of lines in buffer. | |
7245 c N Column number. | |
7246 v N Virtual column number. | |
10 | 7247 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'. |
7 | 7248 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|. |
7249 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the | |
5055 | 7250 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless |
7251 translated. | |
233 | 7252 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max}) |
7 | 7253 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one. |
680 | 7254 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result. |
13742
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7255 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The |
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7256 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to |
18719 | 7257 work around that. See |stl-%{| below. |
7 | 7258 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and |
7259 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere. | |
7260 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed. | |
681 | 7261 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last |
7262 label. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7263 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the | |
7264 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab" | |
7265 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7 | 7266 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start. |
7267 No width fields allowed. | |
7268 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items. | |
7269 No width fields allowed. | |
680 | 7270 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again. |
7271 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same | |
7272 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current | |
7273 windows. | |
7 | 7274 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the |
233 | 7275 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*. |
7 | 7276 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied |
7277 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows. | |
7278 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9| | |
7279 | |
1698 | 7280 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when |
7281 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display | |
7282 when flags are used like in the examples below. | |
7 | 7283 |
233 | 7284 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are |
7 | 7285 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will |
7286 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear | |
7287 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. > | |
7288 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)... | |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7289 < Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7290 line is displayed. |
18719 | 7291 *stl-%{* *g:actual_curbuf* *g:actual_curwin* |
19163 | 7292 While evaluating %{} the current buffer and current window will be set |
7293 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is | |
18719 | 7294 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context. |
7295 The variable "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the | |
7296 real current buffer and "g:actual_curwin" to the |window-ID| of the | |
7297 real current window. These values are strings. | |
634 | 7298 |
3682 | 7299 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from |
7300 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7301 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 7302 |
7303 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
7304 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|. | |
7 | 7305 |
7306 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting | |
7307 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by | |
7308 setting an option without changing its value. Example: > | |
7309 :let &ro = &ro | |
7310 | |
7311 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes. | |
7312 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules | |
7313 described above. | |
7314 | |
199 | 7315 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable! |
7 | 7316 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
7317 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right. |
7 | 7318 |
7319 Examples: | |
7320 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set > | |
7321 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P | |
7322 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") > | |
7323 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P | |
7324 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. > | |
7325 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b' | |
7326 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red | |
7327 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded > | |
7328 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h... | |
7329 < In the |:autocmd|'s: > | |
7330 :let b:gzflag = 1 | |
7331 < And: > | |
7332 :unlet b:gzflag | |
7333 < And define this function: > | |
7334 :function VarExists(var, val) | |
7335 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif | |
7336 :endfunction | |
7337 < | |
7338 *'suffixes'* *'su'* | |
7339 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj") | |
7340 global | |
7341 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files | |
7342 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the | |
10 | 7343 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as |
7344 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a | |
7 | 7345 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about |
7346 including spaces and backslashes). | |
7347 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files. | |
7348 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7349 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7350 uses another default. | |
7351 | |
7352 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'* | |
7353 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "") | |
7354 local to buffer | |
7355 {not available when compiled without the | |
7356 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
7357 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a | |
7358 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: > | |
7359 :set suffixesadd=.java | |
7360 < | |
7361 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'* | |
7362 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on) | |
7363 local to buffer | |
10 | 7364 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a |
7 | 7365 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with |
7366 confidential information that even root must not be able to access. | |
7367 Careful: All text will be in memory: | |
7368 - Don't use this for big files. | |
7369 - Recovery will be impossible! | |
7370 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and | |
7371 'swapfile' is set. | |
7372 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is | |
7373 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is | |
7374 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created. | |
7375 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|. | |
5763 | 7376 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it, |
7377 use the |:noswapfile| modifier. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7378 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created. |
7 | 7379 |
7380 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to | |
7381 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
7382 | |
7383 *'swapsync'* *'sws'* | |
7384 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync") | |
7385 global | |
7386 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after | |
10 | 7387 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems. |
7 | 7388 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and |
7389 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work. | |
7390 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it, | |
7391 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some | |
7392 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system | |
7393 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default | |
7394 fsync(), which may work better on some systems. | |
36 | 7395 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file. |
7 | 7396 |
7397 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'* | |
7398 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "") | |
7399 global | |
7400 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers. | |
7401 Possible values (comma separated list): | |
7402 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that | |
7403 contains the specified buffer (if there is one). | |
7404 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows. | |
7405 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when | |
7406 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is | |
7407 also used in all buffer related split commands, for | |
7408 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind". | |
825 | 7409 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab |
856 | 7410 pages. |
7 | 7411 split If included, split the current window before loading |
3153 | 7412 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors. |
16086 | 7413 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used |
7414 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or | |
7415 split if there is no other window). | |
6843 | 7416 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically. |
1621 | 7417 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
7418 "split" when both are present. |
18646
394abd397e15
patch 8.1.2315: not always using the right window when jumping to an error
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18594
diff
changeset
|
7419 uselast If included, jump to the previously used window when |
394abd397e15
patch 8.1.2315: not always using the right window when jumping to an error
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18594
diff
changeset
|
7420 jumping to errors with |quickfix| commands. |
7 | 7421 |
410 | 7422 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'* |
7423 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000) | |
7424 local to buffer | |
7425 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7426 feature} | |
419 | 7427 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the |
7428 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not | |
7429 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared. | |
410 | 7430 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one |
7431 long line. | |
7432 Set to zero to remove the limit. | |
7433 | |
7 | 7434 *'syntax'* *'syn'* |
7435 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty) | |
7436 local to buffer | |
7437 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7438 feature} | |
7439 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless | |
7440 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off". | |
7441 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the | |
7442 b:current_syntax variable does). | |
7443 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is | |
782 | 7444 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: |
7445 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~ | |
7446 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
7447 names. Example: | |
7448 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
7449 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax. | |
7450 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition, | |
7451 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear. | |
7452 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: > | |
7 | 7453 :set syntax=OFF |
7454 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the | |
7455 'filetype' option: > | |
7456 :set syntax=ON | |
7457 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the | |
7458 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument. | |
7459 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or | |
7460 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 7461 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 7462 |
699 | 7463 *'tabline'* *'tal'* |
677 | 7464 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty) |
674 | 7465 global |
677 | 7466 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages |
7467 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default | |
681 | 7468 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info. |
677 | 7469 |
7470 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline' | |
688 | 7471 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in |
7472 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used | |
2572
ee53a39d5896
Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2570
diff
changeset
|
7473 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different. |
677 | 7474 |
7475 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use | |
7476 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out | |
681 | 7477 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for |
7478 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels. | |
677 | 7479 |
15396
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7480 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not |
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7481 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7482 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
15396
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7483 |
677 | 7484 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others |
7485 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows. | |
7486 | |
674 | 7487 |
699 | 7488 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'* |
7489 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10) | |
7490 global | |
7491 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line | |
7492 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage| | |
7493 | |
7494 | |
7495 *'tabstop'* *'ts'* | |
7 | 7496 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8) |
7497 local to buffer | |
7498 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see | |
7499 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option. | |
7500 | |
7501 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file | |
7502 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it). | |
7503 | |
7504 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim: | |
7505 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4 | |
7506 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim | |
1263 | 7507 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will |
7 | 7508 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters. |
7509 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use | |
7510 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The | |
7511 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed. | |
7512 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a | |
10 | 7513 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only |
7 | 7514 works when using Vim to edit the file. |
7515 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and | |
7516 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only) | |
7517 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have | |
7518 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this | |
7519 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is | |
7520 changed. | |
7521 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7522 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7523 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7524 than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7525 |
7 | 7526 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'* |
7527 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on) | |
7528 global | |
7529 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either | |
10 | 7530 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary |
7 | 7531 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search |
7532 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted. | |
7533 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that | |
7534 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the | |
7535 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off. | |
7536 | |
7537 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags | |
10 | 7538 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for |
7 | 7539 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When |
7540 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done. | |
7541 | |
7542 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line | |
7543 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: > | |
1621 | 7544 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/ |
7 | 7545 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>] |
7546 | |
7547 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7548 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used |
7 | 7549 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search. |
7550 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only | |
7551 be found in the retry. | |
7552 | |
22 | 7553 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second, |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7554 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2' |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7555 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7556 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7557 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7558 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7559 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work. |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7560 |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7561 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7562 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7563 "ignore". |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7564 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7565 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7566 characters. |
7 | 7567 |
7568 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match | |
7569 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags | |
7570 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off. | |
7571 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on | |
7572 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above | |
7573 must be included in the tags file. | |
7574 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g., | |
7575 command-line completion and ":help"). | |
7576 | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7577 *'tagcase'* *'tc'* |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7578 'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic") |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7579 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7580 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7581 file: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7582 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7583 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7584 ignore Ignore case |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7585 match Match case |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7586 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used |
11160 | 7587 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7588 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7589 |
16447
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7590 *'tagfunc'* *'tfu'* |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7591 'tagfunc' 'tfu' string (default: empty) |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7592 local to buffer |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7593 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7594 feature} |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7595 This option specifies a function to be used to perform tag searches. |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7596 The function gets the tag pattern and should return a List of matching |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7597 tags. See |tag-function| for an explanation of how to write the |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7598 function and an example. |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7599 |
7 | 7600 *'taglength'* *'tl'* |
7601 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0) | |
7602 global | |
7603 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters. | |
7604 | |
7605 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'* | |
7606 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7607 global | |
824 | 7608 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that |
7609 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is. | |
7 | 7610 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7611 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7612 | |
7613 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433* | |
7614 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with | |
7615 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS") | |
7616 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7617 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To | |
7618 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash | |
7619 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes). | |
7620 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path | |
7621 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in | |
7622 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see | |
7623 |tags-option|. | |
7624 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in | |
2522
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7625 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7626 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7627 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7628 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7629 |+path_extra| feature} |
515 | 7630 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names |
7631 actually used. | |
7 | 7632 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag |
7633 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The | |
7634 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case | |
7635 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags| | |
7636 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7637 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7638 uses another default. | |
7639 | |
7640 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'* | |
7641 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on) | |
7642 global | |
7643 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or | |
7644 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the | |
7645 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or | |
7646 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified | |
7647 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry. | |
7648 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a | |
7649 mapping which should not change the tagstack. | |
7650 | |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7651 *'tcldll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7652 'tcldll' string (default depends on the build) |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7653 global |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7654 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn| |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7655 feature} |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7656 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7657 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
7658 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7659 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7660 security reasons. |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7661 |
7 | 7662 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531* |
7663 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails: | |
7664 in the GUI: "builtin_gui" | |
7665 on Amiga: "amiga" | |
7666 on BeOS: "beos-ansi" | |
7667 on Mac: "mac-ansi" | |
7668 on MiNT: "vt52" | |
7669 on Unix: "ansi" | |
7670 on VMS: "ansi" | |
7671 on Win 32: "win32") | |
7672 global | |
7673 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control | |
7674 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
7675 For example: > | |
7676 :set term=$TERM | |
7677 < See |termcap|. | |
7678 | |
7679 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'* | |
7680 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'* | |
7681 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm") | |
7682 global | |
7683 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
7684 feature} | |
7685 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified | |
7686 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping | |
7687 that some languages (such as Arabic) require. | |
7688 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when | |
7689 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored. | |
7690 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that | |
7691 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically. | |
7692 This option is reset when the GUI is started. | |
7693 For further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
7694 | |
7695 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'* | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7696 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8"; with |
7 | 7697 Macintosh GUI: "macroman") |
7698 global | |
7699 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character | |
7700 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7701 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the |
1152 | 7702 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then |
7703 'termencoding' should be "macroman". | |
19027
d72b30bf3a80
patch 8.2.0074: Python 3 unicode test someitmes fails
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18972
diff
changeset
|
7704 *E617* *E950* |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7705 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been |
7 | 7706 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8". |
7707 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error | |
7708 message is shown. | |
7080
1a34f5272977
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ac360bf2ca293735fc7c6654dc2b3066f4c62488
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7051
diff
changeset
|
7709 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used, |
7 | 7710 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters. |
7711 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option. | |
7712 This is the normal value. | |
7713 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See | |
7714 |encoding-table|. | |
7715 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or | |
7716 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you | |
7717 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters. | |
7718 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and | |
7719 want to edit a UTF-8 file: > | |
7720 :let &termencoding = &encoding | |
7721 :set encoding=utf-8 | |
7722 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8. | |
7723 | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7724 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954* |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7725 'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off) |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7726 global |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7727 {not available when compiled without the |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7728 |+termguicolors| feature} |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7729 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7730 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color). |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7731 |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7732 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7733 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color| |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7734 might help. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7735 |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7736 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7737 is required. Use this check to find out: > |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7738 if has('vcon') |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7739 < This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature. |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7740 |
11473 | 7741 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones. |
11160 | 7742 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7743 |
13735 | 7744 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'* |
7745 'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7746 local to window |
11914 | 7747 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7748 are sent to the job running in the window. |
11914 | 7749 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: > |
13735 | 7750 :set termwinkey=<C-L> |
11914 | 7751 < The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes. |
7752 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command | |
13735 | 7753 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the |
11914 | 7754 command line. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7755 |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7756 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7757 'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000) |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7758 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7759 {not available when compiled without the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7760 |+terminal| feature} |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7761 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7762 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7763 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7764 |
13735 | 7765 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'* |
7766 'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7767 local to window |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7768 Size of the |terminal| window. Format: {rows}x{columns} or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7769 {rows}*{columns}. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7770 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window. |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7771 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7772 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7773 top-left part is displayed. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7774 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7775 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7776 columns. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7777 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7778 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7779 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7780 |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7781 Examples: |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7782 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7783 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7784 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns. |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7785 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7786 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7787 adjusted to that size, if possible. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7788 |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7789 *'termwintype'* *'twt'* |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7790 'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "") |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7791 global |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7792 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7793 feature on MS-Windows} |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7794 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7795 window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7796 |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7797 Possible values are: |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7798 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7799 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7800 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7801 |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7802 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018 |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7803 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7804 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7805 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7806 supported then you cannot open a terminal window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7807 |
7 | 7808 *'terse'* *'noterse'* |
7809 'terse' boolean (default off) | |
7810 global | |
7811 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message | |
7812 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being | |
7813 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi | |
7814 shortens a lot of messages} | |
7815 | |
7816 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'* | |
7817 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7818 global | |
7819 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'. | |
7820 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is | |
7821 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is | |
7822 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty. | |
7823 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
7824 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7825 | |
7826 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
7827 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (Win32: default on, |
7 | 7828 others: default off) |
7829 local to buffer | |
7830 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'. | |
7831 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is | |
7832 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to | |
7833 "unix". | |
7834 | |
7835 *'textwidth'* *'tw'* | |
7836 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0) | |
7837 local to buffer | |
7838 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be | |
7839 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7840 this. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7841 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7842 when 'paste' is reset. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7843 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also |
7 | 7844 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
838 | 7845 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line. |
7 | 7846 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7847 | |
7848 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'* | |
7849 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "") | |
7850 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7851 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
15033 | 7852 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. |
7853 | |
7854 Each line in the file should contain words with similar meaning, | |
7855 separated by non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). | |
7856 Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
7857 | |
15131 | 7858 An English word list was added to this github issue: |
7859 https://github.com/vim/vim/issues/629#issuecomment-443293282 | |
7860 Unpack thesaurus_pkg.zip, put the thesaurus.txt file somewhere, e.g. | |
7861 ~/.vim/thesaurus/english.txt, and the 'thesaurus' option to this file | |
7862 name. | |
15033 | 7863 |
10 | 7864 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 7865 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
7866 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
7867 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7868 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7869 uses another default. | |
7870 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
7871 | |
7872 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'* | |
7873 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off) | |
7874 global | |
7875 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator. | |
7876 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7877 | |
7878 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'* | |
7879 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on) | |
7880 global | |
7881 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'* | |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7882 'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7883 global |
7884 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a | |
7885 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received: | |
7886 | |
7887 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~ | |
7888 off off do not time out | |
7889 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes | |
7890 off on time out on key codes | |
7891 | |
7892 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete | |
7893 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there | |
7894 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For | |
7895 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next | |
7896 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'. | |
7897 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for | |
7898 the next character to arrive. After that the already received | |
7899 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can | |
7900 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option. | |
7901 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause | |
7902 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits | |
7903 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start | |
7904 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have | |
7905 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key | |
7906 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and | |
7907 reset the 'timeout' option. | |
7908 | |
7909 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7910 | |
7911 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'* | |
7912 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000) | |
7913 global | |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
7914 |
7 | 7915 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'* |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7916 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7917 global |
7918 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key | |
7919 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G | |
7920 when part of a command has been typed. | |
7921 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a | |
7922 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to | |
7923 a non-negative number. | |
7924 | |
7925 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~ | |
7926 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen' | |
7927 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen' | |
7928 | |
7929 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options | |
7930 tell so. A useful setting would be > | |
7931 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100 | |
7932 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after | |
7933 a tenth of a second). | |
7934 | |
7935 *'title'* *'notitle'* | |
7936 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
7937 global | |
7938 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7939 feature} | |
7940 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of | |
7941 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to: | |
7942 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM | |
7943 Where: | |
7944 filename the name of the file being edited | |
7945 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off | |
7946 + indicates the file was modified | |
7947 = indicates the file is read-only | |
7948 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified | |
7949 (path) is the path of the file being edited | |
7950 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM" | |
7951 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles | |
7952 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and | |
7953 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and | |
7954 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap). | |
7955 *X11* | |
7956 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
7957 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11" | |
7958 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also | |
7959 works for the icon name |'icon'|. | |
7960 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title | |
7961 will not work (except in the GUI). | |
7962 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'. | |
7963 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then. | |
7964 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command: | |
7965 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY & | |
7966 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the | |
7967 title of the window should change back to what it should be after | |
7968 exiting Vim. | |
7969 | |
7970 *'titlelen'* | |
7971 'titlelen' number (default 85) | |
7972 global | |
7973 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7974 feature} | |
7975 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window | |
10 | 7976 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is |
7977 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this. | |
7 | 7978 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But |
7979 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters | |
7980 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title | |
7981 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise, | |
7982 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used. | |
7983 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option. | |
7984 | |
7985 *'titleold'* | |
7986 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim") | |
7987 global | |
7988 {only available when compiled with the |+title| | |
7989 feature} | |
7990 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the | |
7991 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or | |
7992 'titlestring' is not empty. | |
36 | 7993 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7994 security reasons. | |
7 | 7995 *'titlestring'* |
7996 'titlestring' string (default "") | |
7997 global | |
7998 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7999 feature} | |
8000 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the | |
8001 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on. | |
8002 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently | |
8003 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a | |
8004 non-empty 't_ts' option). | |
8005 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
8006 be restored if possible, see |X11|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8007 |
7 | 8008 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be |
8009 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8010 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8011 |
7 | 8012 Example: > |
8013 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p") | |
8014 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70 | |
8015 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right | |
8016 of the available space. | |
8017 Some people prefer to have the file name first: > | |
8018 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%) | |
8019 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file, | |
10 | 8020 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a |
7 | 8021 separating space only when needed. |
8022 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display | |
8023 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character). | |
8024 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
8025 | |
8026 *'toolbar'* *'tb'* | |
8027 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips") | |
8028 global | |
8029 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and | |
8030 |+GUI_Photon|} | |
10 | 8031 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The |
7 | 8032 possible values are: |
8033 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons. | |
8034 text Toolbar buttons shown with text. | |
8035 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are | |
10 | 8036 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI} |
7 | 8037 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons. |
8038 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse | |
8039 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment. | |
8040 | |
8041 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the | |
8042 following: > | |
8043 :set tb=icons,text | |
8044 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They | |
8045 will show icons if both are requested. | |
8046 | |
8047 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if | |
8048 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable | |
8049 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: > | |
8050 :set guioptions-=T | |
8051 < Also see |gui-toolbar|. | |
8052 | |
8053 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'* | |
8054 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small") | |
8055 global | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
8056 {only in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 8057 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are: |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8058 tiny Use tiny icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8059 small Use small icons (default). |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8060 medium Use medium-sized icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8061 large Use large icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8062 huge Use even larger icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8063 giant Use very big icons. |
7 | 8064 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8065 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32, |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8066 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16. |
7 | 8067 |
8068 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined | |
8069 by user preferences or the current theme is used. | |
8070 | |
8071 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'* | |
8072 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on) | |
8073 global | |
8074 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones. | |
8075 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones. | |
8076 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for | |
8077 the change to take effect, for example: > | |
8078 :set notbi term=$TERM | |
8079 < See also |termcap|. | |
8080 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin | |
8081 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty | |
8082 xterm entries...). | |
8083 | |
8084 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'* | |
8085 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm, | |
8086 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or | |
8087 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in | |
8088 a DOS console) | |
8089 global | |
8090 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to | |
8091 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line | |
8092 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple | |
8093 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region. | |
8094 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen | |
8095 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the | |
8096 mouse in an xterm and other terminals. | |
8097 | |
8098 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'* | |
8099 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term') | |
8100 global | |
8101 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not | |
8102 available when compiled without |+mouse|} | |
8103 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized. | |
1213 | 8104 Currently these strings are valid: |
7 | 8105 *xterm-mouse* |
8106 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
8107 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes: | |
8108 "s" = button state | |
8109 "c" = column plus 33 | |
8110 "r" = row plus 33 | |
5908 | 8111 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec", |
8112 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions. | |
7 | 8113 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the |
8114 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works | |
8115 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at | |
180 | 8116 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to |
7 | 8117 work. See below for how Vim detects this |
8118 automatically. | |
8119 *netterm-mouse* | |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8120 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. A left mouse click generates |
7 | 8121 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8122 for the row and column. No other mouse events are |
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8123 supported. |
7 | 8124 *dec-mouse* |
8125 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a | |
8126 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[". | |
189 | 8127 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was |
8128 configured with "--enable-dec-locator". | |
7 | 8129 *jsbterm-mouse* |
8130 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling. | |
8131 *pterm-mouse* | |
8132 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling. | |
3224 | 8133 *urxvt-mouse* |
8134 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal. | |
5908 | 8135 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this |
8136 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit | |
8137 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2". | |
3750 | 8138 *sgr-mouse* |
8139 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled | |
5908 | 8140 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns |
8141 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with | |
8142 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style | |
8143 mouse codes. | |
7 | 8144 |
8145 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm| | |
5908 | 8146 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt| |
8147 |+mouse_sgr|. | |
7 | 8148 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always |
8149 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes | |
8150 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not | |
5908 | 8151 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict |
8152 with them). | |
7 | 8153 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is |
10272
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8154 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux", |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8155 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8156 already. |
5908 | 8157 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and |
8158 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version | |
17229
f1c7b7a4d9e4
patch 8.1.1614: 'numberwidth' can only go up to 10
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17161
diff
changeset
|
8159 number, more intelligent detection is done. |
7 | 8160 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be |
15131 | 8161 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac |
8162 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or | |
8163 higher. | |
5908 | 8164 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr" |
8165 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: > | |
7 | 8166 :set t_RV= |
8167 < | |
8168 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'* | |
8169 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999) | |
8170 global | |
8171 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines | |
8172 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is | |
8173 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number, | |
8174 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying. | |
8175 | |
8176 *'ttytype'* *'tty'* | |
8177 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM) | |
8178 global | |
8179 Alias for 'term', see above. | |
8180 | |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8181 *'undodir'* *'udir'* |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8182 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".") |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8183 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8184 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8185 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8186 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format. |
2218
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8187 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8188 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~". |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8189 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8190 file, with path separators replaced with "%". |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8191 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8192 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8193 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8194 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8195 given, no further entry is used. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8196 See |undo-persistence|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8197 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8198 security reasons. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8199 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
8200 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'* |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8201 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off) |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8202 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8203 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8204 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8205 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8206 file on buffer read. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8207 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'. |
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8208 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|. |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8209 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8210 before a reload to be saved for undo. |
3920 | 8211 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted. |
11160 | 8212 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8213 |
7 | 8214 *'undolevels'* *'ul'* |
19116 | 8215 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS and Win32) |
5446 | 8216 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 8217 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information |
18186 | 8218 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used. |
8219 Nevertheless, a single change can already use a large amount of memory. | |
7 | 8220 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes |
8221 itself: > | |
8222 set ul=0 | |
8223 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in | |
8224 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo. | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8225 Also see |undo-two-ways|. |
5446 | 8226 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the |
8227 current buffer: > | |
8228 setlocal ul=-1 | |
7 | 8229 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change. |
6336 | 8230 |
8231 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used. | |
8232 | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8233 Also see |clear-undo|. |
7 | 8234 |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8235 *'undoreload'* *'ur'* |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8236 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000) |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8237 global |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8238 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8239 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8240 Vim. |FileChangedShell| |
12559 | 8241 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8242 of lines is smaller than the value of this option. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8243 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8244 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8245 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8246 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8247 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8248 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory. |
7 | 8249 |
8250 *'updatecount'* *'uc'* | |
8251 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200) | |
8252 global | |
8253 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to | |
8254 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on | |
8255 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting | |
8256 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly | |
8257 mode this option will be initialized to 10000. | |
8258 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|. | |
8259 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are | |
8260 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount' | |
8261 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted. | |
8262 Also see |'swapsync'|. | |
8263 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile" | |
8264 or "nowrite". | |
8265 | |
8266 *'updatetime'* *'ut'* | |
8267 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000) | |
8268 global | |
8269 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be | |
8270 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the | |
8271 |CursorHold| autocommand event. | |
8272 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8273 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8274 'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8275 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8276 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8277 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8278 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8279 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable- |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8280 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8281 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8282 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8283 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8284 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8285 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8286 to use the following: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8287 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8 |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8288 < This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more |
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8289 for every column thereafter. |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8290 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8291 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8292 'varsofttabstop' is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8293 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8294 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8295 'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8296 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8297 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8298 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8299 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8300 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8301 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8302 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8303 < This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8304 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8305 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8306 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop' |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8307 is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8308 |
7 | 8309 *'verbose'* *'vbs'* |
8310 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0) | |
8311 global | |
8312 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing. | |
8313 Currently, these messages are given: | |
8314 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written. | |
8315 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed. | |
712 | 8316 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file. |
7 | 8317 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed. |
8318 >= 9 Every executed autocommand. | |
8319 >= 12 Every executed function. | |
8320 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded. | |
8321 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause. | |
8322 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters). | |
8323 | |
8324 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|. | |
8325 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command. | |
8326 | |
293 | 8327 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not |
8328 displayed. | |
8329 | |
8330 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'* | |
8331 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty) | |
8332 global | |
8333 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name. | |
8334 When the file exists messages are appended. | |
8335 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made | |
2265
b7cb69ab616d
Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2250
diff
changeset
|
8336 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time. |
293 | 8337 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first. |
8338 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not | |
8339 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set. | |
8340 | |
7 | 8341 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'* |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8342 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga and Win32: |
7 | 8343 "$VIM/vimfiles/view", |
8344 for Unix: "~/.vim/view", | |
8345 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view" | |
18972 | 8346 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view") |
7 | 8347 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8348 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8349 feature} |
8350 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|. | |
8351 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8352 security reasons. | |
8353 | |
8354 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'* | |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8355 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir") |
7 | 8356 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8357 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8358 feature} |
8359 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated | |
10 | 8360 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something: |
7 | 8361 word save and restore ~ |
8362 cursor cursor position in file and in window | |
8363 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
8364 fold options | |
8365 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
8366 global values for local options) | |
6213 | 8367 localoptions same as "options" |
7 | 8368 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward |
8369 slashes | |
8370 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8371 on MS-Windows |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8372 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd` |
7 | 8373 |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8374 "slash" and "unix" are useful on MS-Windows when sharing view files |
7 | 8375 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8376 but the MS-Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. |
7 | 8377 |
8378 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528* | |
18912
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8379 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for |
ccd16426a1f9
patch 8.2.0017: OS/2 and MS-DOS are still mentioned
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18879
diff
changeset
|
8380 MS-Windows: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:, |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8381 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8382 for others: '100,<50,s10,h) |
7 | 8383 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8384 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
7 | 8385 feature} |
8386 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8387 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8388 "NONE". |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8389 The string should be a comma separated list of parameters, each |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8390 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter, |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8391 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8392 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8393 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8394 identifying characters and the effect of their value. |
7 | 8395 CHAR VALUE ~ |
3224 | 8396 *viminfo-!* |
7 | 8397 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start |
8398 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase | |
8399 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis" | |
2607 | 8400 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be |
2642 | 8401 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item. |
3224 | 8402 *viminfo-quote* |
7 | 8403 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of |
8404 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a | |
8405 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the | |
8406 start of a comment! | |
3224 | 8407 *viminfo-%* |
7 | 8408 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is |
8409 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not | |
8410 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the | |
7272
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8411 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8412 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8413 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved. |
23 | 8414 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum |
8415 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all | |
8416 buffers are stored. | |
3224 | 8417 *viminfo-'* |
7 | 8418 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks |
8419 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when | |
8420 'viminfo' is non-empty. | |
8421 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the | |
8422 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file. | |
3224 | 8423 *viminfo-/* |
7 | 8424 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be |
10 | 8425 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute |
7 | 8426 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of |
8427 'history' is used. | |
3224 | 8428 *viminfo-:* |
7 | 8429 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be |
10 | 8430 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8431 *viminfo-<* |
7 | 8432 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then |
8433 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are | |
8434 saved. '"' is the old name for this item. | |
8435 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte. | |
3224 | 8436 *viminfo-@* |
7 | 8437 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be |
10 | 8438 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8439 *viminfo-c* |
7 | 8440 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the |
8441 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current | |
233 | 8442 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|. |
3224 | 8443 *viminfo-f* |
7 | 8444 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0 |
8445 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when | |
10 | 8446 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current |
7 | 8447 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo"). |
3224 | 8448 *viminfo-h* |
7 | 8449 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo |
8450 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch" | |
8451 has been used since the last search command. | |
3224 | 8452 *viminfo-n* |
7 | 8453 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8454 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8455 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8456 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are |
9464
be72f4201a1d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9407
diff
changeset
|
8457 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option. |
3224 | 8458 *viminfo-r* |
7 | 8459 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next |
8460 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each | |
8461 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be | |
18972 | 8462 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-Windows you |
7 | 8463 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can |
8464 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is | |
8465 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50 | |
8466 characters. | |
3224 | 8467 *viminfo-s* |
7 | 8468 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are |
8469 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default | |
8470 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text. | |
8471 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit. | |
8472 | |
8473 Example: > | |
8474 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo | |
8475 < | |
8476 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you | |
8477 edited. | |
8478 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be | |
8479 remembered. | |
8480 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped. | |
8481 :0 Command-line history will not be saved. | |
8482 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo". | |
8483 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used, | |
8484 that is, save all of the search history, and also the | |
8485 previous search and substitute patterns. | |
8486 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back. | |
8487 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored. | |
8488 | |
8489 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to | |
8490 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically. | |
8491 | |
8492 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8493 security reasons. | |
11160 | 8494 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
8495 is reset. | |
7 | 8496 |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8497 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'* |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8498 'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "") |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8499 global |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8500 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8501 feature} |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8502 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8503 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8504 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8505 command line flag sets it to "NONE". |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8506 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8507 security reasons. |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8508 |
7 | 8509 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'* |
8510 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "") | |
8511 global | |
8512 {not available when compiled without the | |
8513 |+virtualedit| feature} | |
8514 A comma separated list of these words: | |
8515 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode. | |
8516 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode. | |
8517 all Allow virtual editing in all modes. | |
772 | 8518 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line |
782 | 8519 |
7 | 8520 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is |
1263 | 8521 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end |
7 | 8522 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and |
8523 editing a table. | |
772 | 8524 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just |
8525 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more | |
8526 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line | |
8527 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also | |
782 | 8528 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move |
8529 the cursor after the last character. Use with care! | |
5220 | 8530 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not |
782 | 8531 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left! |
5220 | 8532 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line. |
772 | 8533 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will |
8534 not get a warning for it. | |
11160 | 8535 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 8536 |
8537 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep* | |
8538 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off) | |
8539 global | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8540 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the |
7 | 8541 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted, |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8542 use: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8543 :set vb t_vb= |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8544 < If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8545 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8546 < Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8547 to get a shorter or longer flash. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8548 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8549 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8550 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8551 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell' |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8552 set. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8553 |
7 | 8554 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display |
8555 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f", | |
8556 where 40 is the time in msec. | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8557 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8558 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8559 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8560 |
7 | 8561 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash. |
8562 Also see 'errorbells'. | |
8563 | |
8564 *'warn'* *'nowarn'* | |
8565 'warn' boolean (default on) | |
8566 global | |
8567 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer | |
8568 has been changed. | |
8569 | |
8570 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'* | |
8571 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off) | |
8572 global | |
667 | 8573 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option. |
7 | 8574 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x. |
8575 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and | |
8576 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running. | |
8577 | |
8578 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'* | |
8579 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "") | |
8580 global | |
8581 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the | |
8582 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in | |
8583 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys: | |
8584 char key mode ~ | |
8585 b <BS> Normal and Visual | |
8586 s <Space> Normal and Visual | |
712 | 8587 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended) |
8588 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended) | |
7 | 8589 < <Left> Normal and Visual |
8590 > <Right> Normal and Visual | |
8591 ~ "~" Normal | |
8592 [ <Left> Insert and Replace | |
8593 ] <Right> Insert and Replace | |
8594 For example: > | |
8595 :set ww=<,>,[,] | |
8596 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used. | |
8597 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change | |
8598 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h" | |
8599 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This | |
8600 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and | |
8601 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping | |
8602 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the | |
8603 cursor. | |
714 | 8604 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a |
18130 | 8605 line (not an empty line) then it will not move to the next line. This |
8606 makes "dl", "cl", "yl" etc. work normally. | |
7 | 8607 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
8608 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8609 | |
8610 *'wildchar'* *'wc'* | |
8611 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E) | |
8612 global | |
8613 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the | |
8614 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'. | |
1621 | 8615 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8616 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See |
8617 'wildcharm' for that. | |
8618 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: > | |
8619 :set wc=<Esc> | |
8620 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
8621 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8622 | |
8623 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'* | |
8624 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0)) | |
8625 global | |
8626 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is | |
233 | 8627 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line |
8628 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally | |
7 | 8629 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that |
8630 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: > | |
8631 :set wcm=<C-Z> | |
1621 | 8632 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z> |
7 | 8633 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N. |
8634 | |
8635 *'wildignore'* *'wig'* | |
8636 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "") | |
8637 global | |
8638 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8639 feature} | |
8640 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these | |
3682 | 8641 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or |
8642 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and | |
8643 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this. | |
7 | 8644 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. |
8645 Also see 'suffixes'. | |
8646 Example: > | |
8647 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj | |
8648 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
8649 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
8650 uses another default. | |
8651 | |
2652 | 8652 |
2662 | 8653 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'* |
2652 | 8654 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off) |
8655 global | |
8656 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories. | |
4242 | 8657 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set. |
2652 | 8658 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which |
8659 happens when there are special characters. | |
8660 | |
8661 | |
7 | 8662 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
8663 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 8664 global |
8665 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu| | |
8666 feature} | |
8667 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced | |
8668 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion, | |
8669 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the | |
8670 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is | |
8671 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or | |
8672 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match. | |
8673 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is | |
8674 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode. | |
4159 | 8675 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|. |
7 | 8676 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on |
8677 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls | |
8678 as needed. | |
8679 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used | |
8680 for selecting a completion. | |
8681 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special | |
8682 meanings: | |
8683 | |
8684 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N) | |
8685 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a | |
8686 subdirectory or submenu. | |
8687 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a | |
8688 dot: move into a submenu. | |
8689 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into | |
8690 parent directory or parent menu. | |
8691 | |
8692 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|. | |
8693 | |
8694 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead | |
8695 of selecting a different match, use this: > | |
8696 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left> | |
8697 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right> | |
8698 < | |
8699 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match | |
8700 |hl-WildMenu|. | |
8701 | |
8702 *'wildmode'* *'wim'* | |
8703 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full") | |
8704 global | |
8705 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with | |
10 | 8706 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each |
1152 | 8707 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The |
7 | 8708 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar', |
8709 The second part for the second use, etc. | |
8710 These are the possible values for each part: | |
8711 "" Complete only the first match. | |
8712 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match, | |
8713 the original string is used and then the first match | |
8714 again. | |
8715 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't | |
8716 result in a longer string, use the next part. | |
8717 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is | |
8718 enabled. | |
8719 "list" When more than one match, list all matches. | |
8720 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8721 complete first match. | |
8722 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8723 complete till longest common string. | |
18463
18d7337b6837
patch 8.1.2225: the "last used" info of a buffer is under used
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18456
diff
changeset
|
8724 "list:lastused" When more than one buffer matches, sort buffers |
18d7337b6837
patch 8.1.2225: the "last used" info of a buffer is under used
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
18456
diff
changeset
|
8725 by time last used (other than the current buffer). |
7 | 8726 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases. |
8727 | |
8728 Examples: > | |
8729 :set wildmode=full | |
233 | 8730 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) > |
7 | 8731 :set wildmode=longest,full |
8732 < Complete longest common string, then each full match > | |
8733 :set wildmode=list:full | |
8734 < List all matches and complete each full match > | |
8735 :set wildmode=list,full | |
8736 < List all matches without completing, then each full match > | |
8737 :set wildmode=longest,list | |
8738 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives. | |
1621 | 8739 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8740 |
40 | 8741 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'* |
8742 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "") | |
8743 global | |
8744 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8745 feature} | |
8746 A list of words that change how command line completion is done. | |
8747 Currently only one word is allowed: | |
8748 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of | |
856 | 8749 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match |
40 | 8750 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are: |
8751 d #define | |
8752 f function | |
8753 Also see |cmdline-completion|. | |
8754 | |
7 | 8755 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'* |
8756 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu") | |
8757 global | |
8758 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI} | |
8759 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT | |
8760 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the | |
8761 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and | |
8762 entering special characters. This option tells what to do: | |
8763 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be | |
8764 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be | |
8765 done with the |:simalt| command. | |
8766 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key | |
8767 combinations cannot be mapped. | |
8768 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu | |
10 | 8769 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other |
7 | 8770 keys can be mapped. |
8771 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT | |
8772 key is never used for the menu. | |
36 | 8773 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will |
8774 select the menu, unless it has been mapped. | |
7 | 8775 |
16778
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8776 *'wincolor'* *'wcr'* |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8777 'wincolor' 'wcr' string (default empty) |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8778 local to window |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8779 Highlight group name to use for this window instead of the Normal |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8780 color |hl-Normal|. |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8781 |
164 | 8782 *'window'* *'wi'* |
8783 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1) | |
8784 global | |
8785 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, | |
8786 use 'lines' for that. | |
179 | 8787 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the |
8788 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll | |
8789 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one. | |
164 | 8790 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll |
8791 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines. | |
8792 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than | |
8793 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1. | |
8794 | |
7 | 8795 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591* |
8796 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1) | |
8797 global | |
8798 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard | |
10 | 8799 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the |
1621 | 8800 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the |
8801 cost of the height of other windows. | |
8802 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing. | |
8803 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen. | |
8804 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback | |
8805 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4" | |
8806 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done, | |
8807 using the |VimEnter| event: > | |
8808 au VimEnter * set winheight=999 | |
8809 < Minimum value is 1. | |
8810 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the | |
7 | 8811 height of the current window. |
8812 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set | |
8813 the minimal height for other windows. | |
8814 | |
8815 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'* | |
8816 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off) | |
8817 local to window | |
8818 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8819 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the |
8820 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|. | |
7 | 8821 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8822 | |
782 | 8823 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'* |
8824 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off) | |
8825 local to window | |
8826 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8827 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. |
782 | 8828 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8829 | |
7 | 8830 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'* |
8831 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1) | |
8832 global | |
8833 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8834 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8835 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a | |
8836 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when | |
8837 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.) | |
8838 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window. | |
8839 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8840 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8841 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable. | |
8842 | |
8843 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'* | |
8844 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1) | |
8845 global | |
8846 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8847 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8848 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just | |
8849 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one | |
8850 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere | |
8851 to go.) | |
8852 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window. | |
8853 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8854 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8855 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable. | |
8856 | |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8857 *'winptydll'* |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8858 'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll") |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8859 global |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8860 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8861 feature on MS-Windows} |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8862 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8863 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether was build as a |
12254 | 8864 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8865 a fallback. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8866 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8867 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8868 security reasons. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8869 |
7 | 8870 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592* |
8871 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20) | |
8872 global | |
8873 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard | |
8874 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If | |
8875 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of | |
8876 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window | |
8877 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing. | |
8878 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the | |
8879 width of the current window. | |
8880 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set | |
8881 the minimal width for other windows. | |
8882 | |
8883 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'* | |
8884 'wrap' boolean (default on) | |
8885 local to window | |
8886 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text | |
8887 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that. | |
8888 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and | |
10 | 8889 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap |
8890 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is | |
7 | 8891 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll |
8892 horizontally. | |
8893 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See | |
8894 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary. | |
8895 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: > | |
8896 :set sidescroll=5 | |
8897 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:> | |
8898 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8899 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8900 on. |
7 | 8901 |
8902 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'* | |
8903 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0) | |
8904 local to buffer | |
8905 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping | |
8906 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted | |
8907 and inserting continues on the next line. | |
8908 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause | |
8909 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible. | |
8910 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8911 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8912 is reset. |
16610 | 8913 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
7 | 8914 |
8915 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'* | |
8916 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385* | |
8917 global | |
500 | 8918 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and |
8919 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes. | |
7 | 8920 |
8921 *'write'* *'nowrite'* | |
8922 'write' boolean (default on) | |
8923 global | |
8924 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed. | |
8925 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are | |
10 | 8926 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line |
7 | 8927 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires |
8928 writing a temporary file. | |
8929 | |
8930 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'* | |
8931 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off) | |
8932 global | |
8933 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override. | |
8934 | |
8935 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'* | |
8936 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off | |
8937 otherwise) | |
8938 global | |
8939 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after | |
8940 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is | |
3513 | 8941 also on. |
8942 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write | |
8943 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
8944 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset | |
8945 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write | |
8946 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful). | |
8947 See |backup-table| for another explanation. | |
7 | 8948 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. |
18719 | 8949 Depending on 'backupcopy' the backup is a new file or the original |
8950 file renamed (and a new file is written). | |
7 | 8951 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is |
8952 set. | |
8953 | |
8954 *'writedelay'* *'wd'* | |
8955 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0) | |
8956 global | |
9344
33c1b85d408c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/802a0d902fca423acb15f835d7b09183883d79a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9286
diff
changeset
|
8957 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the |
7 | 8958 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by |
18972 | 8959 one. For debugging purposes. |
7 | 8960 |
14421 | 8961 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: |